3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
10 Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
11 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
15 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
16 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
17 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
18 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
19 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
20 License'' in the Emacs manual.
22 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
23 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
24 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
26 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
27 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
28 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
29 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
35 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
36 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
37 \usepackage{pagestyle}
40 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
42 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
44 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
52 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.10.6}
53 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
54 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
56 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
58 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
59 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
60 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
62 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
64 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
65 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
67 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
68 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
70 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
71 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
77 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
78 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
79 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
80 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
81 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
82 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
87 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
88 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
89 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
95 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
96 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
97 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
98 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
99 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
100 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
101 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
103 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
104 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
106 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
109 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
110 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
111 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
114 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
116 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
120 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
123 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
125 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
127 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
128 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
129 \thispagestyle{empty}
131 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
132 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
133 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
138 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
140 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
147 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
148 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
151 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
152 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
155 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
156 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
159 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
160 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
163 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
165 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
166 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
170 \newenvironment{codelist}%
175 \newenvironment{asislist}%
180 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
186 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
191 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
196 \newenvironment{samplist}%
201 \newenvironment{varlist}%
206 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
211 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
212 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
213 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
215 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
220 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
224 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
233 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
235 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
240 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
245 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
249 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
257 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
259 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
269 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
273 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
281 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
283 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
288 \pagenumbering{roman}
289 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
300 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
301 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
303 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
305 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
308 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
311 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
318 \thispagestyle{empty}
332 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
337 @setchapternewpage odd
344 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
346 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
352 @top The Gnus Newsreader
356 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
357 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
358 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
361 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.10.6.
372 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
373 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
375 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
376 being accused of plagiarism:
378 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
379 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
380 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
381 can even read news with it!
383 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
384 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
385 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
386 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
387 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
393 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
394 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
395 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
396 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
397 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
398 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
399 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
400 * Various:: General purpose settings.
401 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
402 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
403 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
404 * Key Index:: Key Index.
406 Other related manuals
408 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
409 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
410 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
411 * PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
414 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
418 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
419 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
420 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
421 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
422 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
423 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
424 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
425 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
426 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
427 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
428 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
432 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
433 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
434 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
438 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
439 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
440 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
441 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
442 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
443 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
444 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
445 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
446 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
447 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
448 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
449 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
450 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
451 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
452 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
453 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
454 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
458 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
459 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
460 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
464 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
465 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
466 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
467 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
468 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
472 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
473 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
474 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
475 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
476 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
480 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
481 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
482 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
483 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
484 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
485 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
486 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
487 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
488 * Threading:: How threads are made.
489 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
490 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
491 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
492 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
493 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
494 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
495 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
496 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
497 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
498 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
499 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
500 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
501 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
502 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
503 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
504 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
505 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
506 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
507 or reselecting the current group.
508 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
509 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
510 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
511 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
513 Summary Buffer Format
515 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
516 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
517 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
518 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
522 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
523 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
525 Reply, Followup and Post
527 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
528 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
529 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
530 * Canceling and Superseding::
534 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
535 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
536 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
537 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
538 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
539 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
543 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
544 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
546 Customizing Threading
548 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
549 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
550 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
551 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
555 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
556 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
557 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
558 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
559 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
560 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
564 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
565 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
566 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
570 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
571 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
572 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
573 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
574 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
575 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
576 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
577 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
578 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
579 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
580 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
582 Alternative Approaches
584 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
585 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
587 Various Summary Stuff
589 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
590 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
591 * Summary Generation Commands::
592 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
596 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
597 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
598 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
599 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
600 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
604 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
605 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
606 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
607 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
608 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
609 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
610 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
611 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
612 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
616 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
617 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
618 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
619 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
620 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
621 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
622 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
623 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
627 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
628 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
629 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
630 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
631 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
632 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
633 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
637 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
638 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
642 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
643 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
644 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
648 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
649 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
650 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
651 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
652 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
653 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
654 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
655 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
656 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
657 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
658 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
659 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
660 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
664 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
665 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
666 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
668 Choosing a Mail Back End
670 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
671 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
672 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
673 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
674 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
675 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
676 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
681 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
682 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
683 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
684 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
685 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
686 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
690 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
691 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
692 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
693 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
694 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
695 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
699 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
700 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
701 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
702 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
703 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
707 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
711 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
712 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
713 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
717 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
718 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
722 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
723 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
724 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
725 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
726 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
727 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
728 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
729 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
730 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
731 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
732 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
733 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
734 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
738 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
739 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
740 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
744 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
745 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
746 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
750 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
751 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
752 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
753 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
754 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
755 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
756 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
757 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
758 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
759 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
760 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
761 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
762 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
763 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
764 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
765 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
766 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
770 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
771 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
772 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
773 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
777 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
778 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
779 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
783 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
784 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
785 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
786 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
787 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
788 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
789 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
790 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
791 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
792 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
793 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
794 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
795 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
796 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
797 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
798 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
799 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
800 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
801 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
802 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
806 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
807 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
808 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
809 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
810 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
811 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
812 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
813 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
817 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
818 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
819 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
820 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
821 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
825 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
826 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
827 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
828 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
829 * Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package::
830 * Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat::
832 Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
834 * Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events::
835 * Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail::
836 * Spam ELisp Package Global Variables::
837 * Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples::
838 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
840 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
841 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
843 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
845 * ifile spam filtering::
846 * spam-stat spam filtering::
848 * Extending the Spam ELisp package::
850 Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
852 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
853 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
854 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
858 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
859 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
860 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
861 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
862 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
863 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
864 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
865 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
866 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
870 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
871 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
872 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
873 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
874 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
875 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
876 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
877 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
878 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
882 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
883 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
884 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
885 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
886 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
887 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
891 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
892 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
893 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
894 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
898 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
899 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
900 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
901 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
902 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
903 * Group Info:: The group info format.
904 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
905 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
906 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
910 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
911 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
912 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
913 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
914 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
915 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
919 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
920 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
924 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
925 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
931 @chapter Starting Gnus
936 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
937 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
940 @findex gnus-other-frame
941 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
942 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
943 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
945 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
946 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
947 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
949 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
950 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
953 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
954 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
955 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
956 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
957 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
958 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
959 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
960 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
961 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
962 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
966 @node Finding the News
967 @section Finding the News
970 @vindex gnus-select-method
972 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
973 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
974 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
975 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
978 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
979 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
982 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
985 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
988 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
991 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
992 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
993 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
994 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
996 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
998 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
999 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1000 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1001 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1002 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1003 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1004 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1006 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1007 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1008 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1009 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1011 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1012 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1013 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1014 @acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1015 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1016 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1017 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1018 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1019 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1022 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1024 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1025 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1026 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1027 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1028 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1029 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1031 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1033 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1034 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1035 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1036 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1037 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1038 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1041 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1042 you would typically set this variable to
1045 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1049 @node The First Time
1050 @section The First Time
1051 @cindex first time usage
1053 If no startup files exist (@pxref{Startup Files}), Gnus will try to
1054 determine what groups should be subscribed by default.
1056 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1057 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1058 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1059 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1062 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1063 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1064 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1066 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1067 help you with most common problems.
1069 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1070 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1074 @node The Server is Down
1075 @section The Server is Down
1076 @cindex server errors
1078 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1079 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1080 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1082 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1083 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1084 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1085 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1086 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1087 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1088 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1090 @findex gnus-no-server
1091 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1093 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1094 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1095 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1096 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1097 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1098 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1099 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1103 @section Slave Gnusae
1106 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1107 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1108 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1109 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1111 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1112 @file{.newsrc} file.
1114 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1115 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1116 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1117 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1118 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1119 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1120 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1123 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1124 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1125 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1126 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1127 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1128 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1129 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1130 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1132 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1133 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1135 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1136 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1137 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1138 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1139 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1146 @cindex subscription
1148 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1149 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1150 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1151 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1152 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1153 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1154 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1155 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1156 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1159 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1160 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1161 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1165 @node Checking New Groups
1166 @subsection Checking New Groups
1168 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1169 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1170 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1171 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1172 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1173 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1174 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1175 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1176 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1177 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1179 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1180 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1181 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1182 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1183 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1184 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1185 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1186 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1187 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1188 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1189 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1191 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1192 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1193 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1194 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1195 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1196 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1199 @node Subscription Methods
1200 @subsection Subscription Methods
1202 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1203 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1204 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1206 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1207 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1209 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1213 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1214 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1215 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1216 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1217 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1219 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1220 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1221 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1222 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1224 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1225 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1226 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1228 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1229 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1230 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1231 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1232 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1233 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1234 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1235 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1236 up. Or something like that.
1238 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1239 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1240 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1241 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1242 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1244 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1245 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1246 Kill all new groups.
1248 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1249 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1250 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1251 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1252 topic parameter that looks like
1258 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1261 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1266 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1267 A closely related variable is
1268 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1269 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1270 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1271 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1274 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1275 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1276 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1277 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1280 @node Filtering New Groups
1281 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1283 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1284 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1285 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1288 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1291 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1292 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1293 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1294 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1295 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1296 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1297 subscribing these groups.
1298 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1299 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1301 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1302 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1303 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1304 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1305 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1306 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1307 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1308 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1310 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1311 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1312 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1313 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1314 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1315 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1316 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1317 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1318 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1319 subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1322 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1323 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1326 @node Changing Servers
1327 @section Changing Servers
1328 @cindex changing servers
1330 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1331 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1332 very flaky and you want to use another.
1334 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1335 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1339 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1340 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1341 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1342 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1345 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1346 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1347 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1348 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1350 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1351 @findex gnus-change-server
1352 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1353 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1354 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1355 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1356 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1358 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1359 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1360 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1361 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1362 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1364 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1365 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1366 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1367 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1368 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1369 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1371 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1372 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1373 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1374 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1376 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1377 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1378 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1379 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1380 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1381 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1382 cache for all groups).
1386 @section Startup Files
1387 @cindex startup files
1392 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1393 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1394 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1397 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1398 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1399 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1400 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1401 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1402 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1403 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1405 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1406 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1407 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1408 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1409 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1410 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1412 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1413 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1414 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1415 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1416 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1417 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1418 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1419 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1420 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1421 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1422 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1425 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1426 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1427 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1428 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1429 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1430 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1431 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1432 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1433 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1434 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1435 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1436 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1438 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1439 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1440 @vindex version-control
1441 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1442 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1443 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1444 If you want version control for this file, set
1445 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1446 @code{version-control} variable.
1448 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1449 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1450 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1451 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1452 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1453 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1454 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1455 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1456 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1457 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1460 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1461 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1463 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1464 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1467 @vindex gnus-init-file
1468 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1469 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1470 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1471 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1472 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1473 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1474 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1475 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1476 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1477 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1478 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1479 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1480 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1485 @cindex dribble file
1488 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1489 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1490 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1491 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1492 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1495 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1496 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1499 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1500 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1501 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1503 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1504 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1505 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1506 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1507 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1508 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1510 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1511 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1512 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1515 @node The Active File
1516 @section The Active File
1518 @cindex ignored groups
1520 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1521 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1522 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1524 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1525 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1526 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1527 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1528 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1529 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1530 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1533 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1534 @c if you set it to anything else.
1536 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1538 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1539 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1540 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1542 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1543 you actually subscribe to.
1545 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1546 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1547 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1548 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1550 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1551 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1552 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1553 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1554 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1555 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1557 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1558 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1559 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1562 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1563 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1564 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1565 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1566 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1567 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1569 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1570 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1572 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1573 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1575 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1576 secondary select methods.
1579 @node Startup Variables
1580 @section Startup Variables
1584 @item gnus-load-hook
1585 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1586 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1587 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1588 times you start Gnus.
1590 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1591 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1592 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1594 @item gnus-startup-hook
1595 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1596 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1598 @item gnus-started-hook
1599 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1600 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1603 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1604 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1605 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1606 generating the group buffer.
1608 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1609 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1610 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1611 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1612 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1613 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1614 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1615 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1617 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1618 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1619 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1620 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1621 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1622 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1624 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1625 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1626 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1628 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1629 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1630 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1632 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1633 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1634 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1635 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1641 @chapter Group Buffer
1642 @cindex group buffer
1644 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1646 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1647 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1648 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1649 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1650 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1651 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1652 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1653 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1654 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1655 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1656 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1657 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1658 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1659 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1660 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1661 @c human rights at 9...
1664 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1665 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1666 long as Gnus is active.
1670 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1671 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1672 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1673 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1674 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1675 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1676 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1677 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1683 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1684 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1685 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1686 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1687 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1688 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1689 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1690 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1691 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1692 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1693 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1694 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1695 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1696 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1697 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1698 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1699 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1703 @node Group Buffer Format
1704 @section Group Buffer Format
1707 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1708 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1709 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1713 @node Group Line Specification
1714 @subsection Group Line Specification
1715 @cindex group buffer format
1717 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1718 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1720 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1723 25: news.announce.newusers
1724 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1729 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1730 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1731 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1732 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1734 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1735 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1736 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1737 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1738 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1739 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1741 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1743 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1744 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1745 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1746 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1747 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1749 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1750 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1751 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1753 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1758 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1761 Whether the group is subscribed.
1764 Level of subscribedness.
1767 Number of unread articles.
1770 Number of dormant articles.
1773 Number of ticked articles.
1776 Number of read articles.
1779 Number of unseen articles.
1782 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1783 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1785 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1786 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1787 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1788 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1789 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1790 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1791 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job. If you
1792 want to work on this, please contact the Gnus mailing list.
1795 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1798 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1807 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1808 comment element in the group parameters.
1811 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1812 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1813 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1817 @samp{m} if moderated.
1820 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1826 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1832 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1836 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1839 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1840 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1841 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1842 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1843 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1846 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1848 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1852 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1855 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1859 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1860 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1861 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1862 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1863 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1864 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1869 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1870 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1871 group, or a bogus native group.
1874 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1875 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1876 @cindex group mode line
1878 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1879 The mode line can be changed by setting
1880 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1881 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1885 The native news server.
1887 The native select method.
1891 @node Group Highlighting
1892 @subsection Group Highlighting
1893 @cindex highlighting
1894 @cindex group highlighting
1896 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1897 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1898 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1899 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1900 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1902 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1906 (cond (window-system
1907 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1908 (defface my-group-face-1
1909 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1910 (defface my-group-face-2
1911 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1912 "Second group face")
1913 (defface my-group-face-3
1914 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1915 (defface my-group-face-4
1916 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1917 (defface my-group-face-5
1918 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1920 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1921 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1922 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1923 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1924 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1925 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1928 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1930 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1937 The number of unread articles in the group.
1941 Whether the group is a mail group.
1943 The level of the group.
1945 The score of the group.
1947 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1949 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1950 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1952 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1953 topic being inserted.
1956 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1957 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1958 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1960 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1961 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1962 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1963 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1964 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1967 @node Group Maneuvering
1968 @section Group Maneuvering
1969 @cindex group movement
1971 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1972 expected, hopefully.
1978 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1979 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1980 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1986 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1987 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1988 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1992 @findex gnus-group-next-group
1993 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
1997 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
1998 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2002 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2003 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2004 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2008 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2009 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2010 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2013 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2019 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2020 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2021 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2026 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2027 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2028 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2032 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2033 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2034 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2037 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2038 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2039 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2040 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2044 @node Selecting a Group
2045 @section Selecting a Group
2046 @cindex group selection
2051 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2052 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2053 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2054 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2055 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2056 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2057 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2058 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2059 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2060 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2062 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2063 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2064 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2066 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2067 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2072 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2073 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2074 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2075 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2076 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2080 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2081 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2082 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2083 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2084 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2085 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2086 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2087 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2088 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2089 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2092 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2093 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2094 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2095 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2096 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2099 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2100 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2101 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2102 doing any processing of its contents
2103 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2104 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2105 manner will have no permanent effects.
2109 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2110 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2111 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2112 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2113 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2114 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2115 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2116 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2117 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2118 most recently will be fetched.
2120 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2121 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2122 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2125 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2126 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2127 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2128 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2129 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2130 Which article this is is controlled by the
2131 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2137 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2140 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2143 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2145 @item unseen-or-unread
2146 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2147 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2151 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2155 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2156 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2158 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2159 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2160 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2161 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2165 @node Subscription Commands
2166 @section Subscription Commands
2167 @cindex subscription
2175 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2176 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2177 Toggle subscription to the current group
2178 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2184 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2185 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2186 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2187 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2193 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2194 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2195 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2201 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2202 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2205 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2206 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2207 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2208 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2209 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2215 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2216 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2220 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2221 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2224 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2225 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2226 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2227 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2228 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2229 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2230 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2231 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2232 @file{.newsrc} file.
2236 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2246 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2247 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2248 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2249 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2250 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2251 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2256 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2257 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2258 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2262 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2263 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2264 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2266 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2267 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2268 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2269 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2270 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2271 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2278 @section Group Levels
2282 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2283 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2284 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2285 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2286 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2288 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2294 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2295 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2296 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2297 prompted for a level.
2300 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2301 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2302 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2303 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2304 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2305 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2306 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2307 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2308 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2309 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2310 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2311 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2312 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2313 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2314 reasons of efficiency.
2316 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2317 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2319 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2320 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2321 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2322 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2323 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2324 groups are hidden, in a way.
2326 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2327 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2328 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2329 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2330 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2331 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2333 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2334 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2335 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2336 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2337 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2338 list of killed groups.)
2340 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2341 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2342 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2344 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2345 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2346 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2347 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2348 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2349 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2350 relevant valid ranges.
2352 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2353 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2354 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2355 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2356 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2357 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2360 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2361 one with the best level.
2363 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2364 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2365 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2368 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2369 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2370 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2371 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2374 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2375 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2376 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2377 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2379 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2380 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2381 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2382 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2383 to 5. The default is 6.
2387 @section Group Score
2392 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2393 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2394 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2397 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2398 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2399 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2400 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2401 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2402 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2403 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2404 least significant part.))
2406 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2407 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2408 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2409 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2410 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2411 action after each summary exit, you can add
2412 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2413 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2414 slow things down somewhat.
2417 @node Marking Groups
2418 @section Marking Groups
2419 @cindex marking groups
2421 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2422 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2423 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2424 bidding on those groups.
2426 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2427 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2428 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2436 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2437 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2443 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2444 Remove the mark from the current group
2445 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2449 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2450 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2454 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2455 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2459 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2460 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2464 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2465 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2466 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2469 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2471 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2472 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2473 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2474 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2475 the command to be executed.
2478 @node Foreign Groups
2479 @section Foreign Groups
2480 @cindex foreign groups
2482 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2483 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2484 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2485 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2492 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2493 @cindex making groups
2494 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2495 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2496 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2500 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2501 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2502 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2506 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2507 @cindex renaming groups
2508 Rename the current group to something else
2509 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2510 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2516 @findex gnus-group-customize
2517 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2521 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2522 @cindex renaming groups
2523 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2524 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2528 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2529 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2530 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2534 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2535 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2536 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2540 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2542 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2543 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2548 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2549 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2553 @cindex (ding) archive
2554 @cindex archive group
2555 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2556 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2557 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2558 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2559 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2560 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2561 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2565 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2567 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2568 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2569 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2570 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2574 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2576 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2577 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2578 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2582 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2583 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2585 Make a group based on some file or other
2586 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2587 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2588 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2589 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2590 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2591 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2592 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2593 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2594 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2598 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2599 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2600 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2601 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2605 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2609 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2610 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2611 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2612 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2613 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2614 @xref{Web Searches}.
2616 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2617 to a particular group by using a match string like
2618 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2622 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2623 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2624 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2628 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2629 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2630 This function will delete the current group
2631 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2632 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2633 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2634 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2635 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2639 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2640 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2641 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2645 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2646 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2647 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2650 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2653 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2654 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2655 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2656 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2657 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2658 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2662 @node Group Parameters
2663 @section Group Parameters
2664 @cindex group parameters
2666 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2667 Here's an example group parameter list:
2670 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2674 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2675 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2676 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2677 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2679 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2680 is an alist of regexps and values.
2682 The following group parameters can be used:
2687 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2690 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2693 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2694 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2695 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2696 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2697 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2699 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2700 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2701 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2702 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2703 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2704 list address instead.
2706 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2710 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2713 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2716 It is totally ignored
2717 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2718 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2720 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2721 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2722 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2723 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2724 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2726 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2727 @cindex mail list groups
2728 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2729 entering summary buffer.
2731 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2736 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2737 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2738 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2739 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2740 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2741 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2742 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2743 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2746 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2747 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2750 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2751 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2755 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2756 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2757 of whether it has any unread articles.
2759 @item broken-reply-to
2760 @cindex broken-reply-to
2761 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2762 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2763 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2764 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2765 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2766 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2770 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2771 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2775 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2776 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2777 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2782 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2783 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2784 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2785 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2786 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2787 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2788 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2790 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2791 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2792 doesn't accept articles.
2796 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2797 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2798 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2800 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2803 @cindex total-expire
2804 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2805 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2806 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2807 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2810 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2814 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2815 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2816 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2817 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2818 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2819 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2820 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2823 @cindex expiry-target
2824 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2825 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2828 @cindex score file group parameter
2829 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2830 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2831 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2834 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2835 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2836 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2837 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2840 @cindex admin-address
2841 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2842 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2843 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2844 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2848 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2849 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2853 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2856 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2857 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2860 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2864 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2866 Here are some examples:
2870 Display only unread articles.
2873 Display everything except expirable articles.
2875 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2876 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2880 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2881 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2882 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2883 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2884 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
2888 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2889 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2890 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2894 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2895 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2896 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2900 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2901 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2902 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2904 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2906 @item ignored-charsets
2907 @cindex ignored-charset
2908 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
2909 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2910 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2912 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2915 @cindex posting-style
2916 You can store additional posting style information for this group
2917 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2918 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2919 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2920 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2922 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2923 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2924 like this in the group parameters:
2929 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
2930 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2935 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
2936 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
2940 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
2941 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
2942 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
2943 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
2944 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
2948 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
2949 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
2950 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
2951 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
2953 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
2954 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
2955 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
2956 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
2959 if address \"sender\" \"sieve-admin@@extundo.com\" @{
2960 fileinto \"INBOX.list.sieve\";
2964 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
2965 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
2967 @item (agent parameters)
2968 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
2969 to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
2970 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
2971 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
2972 minimize the configuration effort.
2974 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
2975 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
2976 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
2977 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
2978 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
2979 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
2980 @code{eval}ed there.
2982 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer.
2983 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
2984 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
2985 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
2986 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
2987 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
2988 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
2989 @file{~/.gnus} file:
2992 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
2995 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
2996 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
2997 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3000 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3003 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3004 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3005 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3006 into the group parameters for the group.
3008 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3009 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3010 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group.
3011 @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the (meaningless) result of the
3014 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3015 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3016 following is added to a group parameter
3019 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3020 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3023 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3028 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
3029 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
3030 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
3031 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
3032 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
3034 @vindex gnus-parameters
3035 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3036 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect. For
3040 (setq gnus-parameters
3042 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3043 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3044 (gnus-summary-line-format
3045 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3049 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3053 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3057 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3060 String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3061 the @code{to-group} example shows.
3063 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3064 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3065 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3066 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3067 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3068 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3069 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3070 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3071 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3072 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3073 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3074 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3077 @node Listing Groups
3078 @section Listing Groups
3079 @cindex group listing
3081 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3089 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3090 List all groups that have unread articles
3091 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3092 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3093 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3094 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3101 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3102 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3103 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3104 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3105 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3106 unsubscribed groups).
3110 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3111 List all unread groups on a specific level
3112 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3113 with no unread articles.
3117 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3118 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3119 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3120 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3125 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3126 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3130 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3131 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3132 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3136 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3137 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3141 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3142 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3143 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3144 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3145 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3146 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3147 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3148 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3152 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3153 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3154 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3158 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3159 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3160 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3164 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3165 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3169 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3170 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3174 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3175 List groups limited within the current selection
3176 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3180 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3181 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3185 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3186 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3190 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3191 @cindex visible group parameter
3192 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3193 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3194 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3195 get the same effect.
3197 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3198 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3199 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3200 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3201 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3204 @node Sorting Groups
3205 @section Sorting Groups
3206 @cindex sorting groups
3208 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3209 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3210 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3211 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3212 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3213 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3218 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3219 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3220 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3222 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3223 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3224 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3226 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3227 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3228 Sort by group level.
3230 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3231 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3232 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3234 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3235 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3236 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3237 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3239 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3240 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3241 Sort by number of unread articles.
3243 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3244 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3245 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3247 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3248 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3249 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3254 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3255 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3259 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3260 some sorting criteria:
3264 @kindex G S a (Group)
3265 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3266 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3267 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3270 @kindex G S u (Group)
3271 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3272 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3273 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3276 @kindex G S l (Group)
3277 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3278 Sort the group buffer by group level
3279 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3282 @kindex G S v (Group)
3283 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3284 Sort the group buffer by group score
3285 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3288 @kindex G S r (Group)
3289 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3290 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3291 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3294 @kindex G S m (Group)
3295 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3296 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3297 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3300 @kindex G S n (Group)
3301 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3302 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3303 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3307 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3308 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3310 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3311 commands will sort in reverse order.
3313 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3317 @kindex G P a (Group)
3318 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3319 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3320 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3323 @kindex G P u (Group)
3324 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3325 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3326 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3329 @kindex G P l (Group)
3330 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3331 Sort the groups by group level
3332 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3335 @kindex G P v (Group)
3336 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3337 Sort the groups by group score
3338 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3341 @kindex G P r (Group)
3342 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3343 Sort the groups by group rank
3344 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3347 @kindex G P m (Group)
3348 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3349 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3350 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3353 @kindex G P n (Group)
3354 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3355 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3356 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3359 @kindex G P s (Group)
3360 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3361 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3365 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3369 @node Group Maintenance
3370 @section Group Maintenance
3371 @cindex bogus groups
3376 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3377 Find bogus groups and delete them
3378 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3382 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3383 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3384 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3385 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3386 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3390 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3391 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3392 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3393 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3394 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3395 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3398 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3399 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3400 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3401 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3406 @node Browse Foreign Server
3407 @section Browse Foreign Server
3408 @cindex foreign servers
3409 @cindex browsing servers
3414 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3415 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3416 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3417 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3420 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3421 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3422 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3423 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3425 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3430 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3431 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3435 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3436 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3439 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3440 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3441 Enter the current group and display the first article
3442 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3445 @kindex RET (Browse)
3446 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3447 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3451 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3452 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3453 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3459 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3460 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3464 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3465 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3469 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3470 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3471 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3476 @section Exiting Gnus
3477 @cindex exiting Gnus
3479 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3484 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3485 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3486 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3487 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3491 @findex gnus-group-exit
3492 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3493 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3497 @findex gnus-group-quit
3498 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3499 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3502 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3503 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3504 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3505 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3506 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3507 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3513 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3514 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3515 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3521 @section Group Topics
3524 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3525 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3526 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3527 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3528 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3529 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3533 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3534 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3545 2: alt.religion.emacs
3548 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3550 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3551 13: comp.sources.unix
3554 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3556 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3557 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3558 is a toggling command.)
3560 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3561 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3562 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3563 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3566 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3567 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3568 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3571 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3575 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3576 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3577 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3578 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3579 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3583 @node Topic Commands
3584 @subsection Topic Commands
3585 @cindex topic commands
3587 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3588 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3589 definitions slightly.
3591 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3592 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3593 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3594 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3595 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3596 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3598 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3605 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3606 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3607 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3611 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3613 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3614 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3615 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3616 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3619 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3620 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3621 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3622 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3626 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3627 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3628 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3629 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3635 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3636 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3637 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3641 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3642 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3643 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3646 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3647 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3648 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3649 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3650 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3652 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3653 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3657 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3658 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3665 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3667 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3668 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3669 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3670 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3671 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3672 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3676 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3682 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3683 Move the current group to some other topic
3684 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3685 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3689 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3690 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3694 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3695 Copy the current group to some other topic
3696 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3697 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3701 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3702 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3703 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3707 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3708 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3709 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3713 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3714 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3715 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3716 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3717 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3718 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3719 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3722 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3723 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3727 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3728 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3729 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3733 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3734 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3735 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3739 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3740 Toggle hiding empty topics
3741 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3745 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3746 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3747 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3748 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3751 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3752 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3753 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3754 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3755 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3758 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3759 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3760 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3761 expiry process (if any)
3762 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3766 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3767 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3770 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3771 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3772 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3776 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3777 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3778 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3781 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3782 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3783 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3786 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3787 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3788 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3792 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3793 @cindex group parameters
3794 @cindex topic parameters
3796 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3797 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3802 @node Topic Variables
3803 @subsection Topic Variables
3804 @cindex topic variables
3806 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3807 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3809 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3810 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3811 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3824 Number of groups in the topic.
3826 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3828 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3831 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3832 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3833 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3836 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3837 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3839 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3840 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3841 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3845 @subsection Topic Sorting
3846 @cindex topic sorting
3848 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3854 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3855 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3856 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3857 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3860 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3861 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3862 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3863 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3866 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3867 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3868 Sort the current topic by group level
3869 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3872 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3873 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3874 Sort the current topic by group score
3875 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3878 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3879 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3880 Sort the current topic by group rank
3881 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3884 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3885 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3886 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
3887 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3890 @kindex T S e (Topic)
3891 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
3892 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
3893 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
3896 @kindex T S s (Topic)
3897 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
3898 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
3899 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
3900 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
3904 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
3905 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
3909 @node Topic Topology
3910 @subsection Topic Topology
3911 @cindex topic topology
3914 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3921 2: alt.religion.emacs
3924 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3926 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3927 13: comp.sources.unix
3931 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3932 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3933 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3938 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
3939 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
3943 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
3944 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
3945 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
3946 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
3947 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
3948 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
3950 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
3951 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
3952 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
3955 @node Topic Parameters
3956 @subsection Topic Parameters
3957 @cindex topic parameters
3959 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
3960 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
3961 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
3962 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
3963 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
3965 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
3970 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
3971 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
3972 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
3975 @item subscribe-level
3976 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
3977 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
3978 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
3982 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
3983 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
3984 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
3985 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
3992 2: alt.religion.emacs
3996 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3998 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3999 13: comp.sources.unix
4004 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4005 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4006 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4007 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4008 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4009 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4011 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4012 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4013 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4014 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4015 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4017 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4018 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4019 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4020 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4021 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4022 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4023 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4024 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4027 @node Misc Group Stuff
4028 @section Misc Group Stuff
4031 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4032 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4033 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4034 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4035 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4042 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4043 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4044 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4048 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4049 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4050 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4051 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4052 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4053 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4054 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4058 @findex gnus-group-mail
4059 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4060 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4061 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4062 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4066 @findex gnus-group-news
4067 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4068 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4069 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4071 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4072 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4073 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4074 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4075 for this to work though.
4079 Variables for the group buffer:
4083 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4084 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4085 is called after the group buffer has been
4088 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4089 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4090 is called after the group buffer is
4091 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4094 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4095 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4096 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4097 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4099 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4100 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4101 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4102 whether they are empty or not.
4104 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4105 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4106 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
4107 non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4111 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4112 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4115 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4116 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4117 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4118 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names. It
4119 is used to show non-@acronym{ASCII} group names. @code{((".*"
4120 utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported, otherwise the
4121 default is @code{nil}.
4125 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4126 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
4131 @node Scanning New Messages
4132 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4133 @cindex new messages
4134 @cindex scanning new news
4140 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4141 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4142 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4143 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4144 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4145 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4150 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4151 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4152 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4153 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4154 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4155 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4156 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4158 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4159 @cindex activating groups
4161 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4162 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4167 @findex gnus-group-restart
4168 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4169 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4170 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4174 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4175 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4177 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4178 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4182 @node Group Information
4183 @subsection Group Information
4184 @cindex group information
4185 @cindex information on groups
4192 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
4193 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
4196 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
4197 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
4198 from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
4199 a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
4200 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
4201 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
4202 used for fetching the file.
4204 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
4205 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
4209 @findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
4210 @vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
4212 Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
4213 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
4216 Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
4217 the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
4218 messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
4222 @findex gnus-group-fetch-control
4223 @vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
4224 @cindex control message
4225 Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
4226 @code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
4227 group if given a prefix argument.
4229 If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
4230 Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
4231 @code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
4232 and displayed in an ephemeral group.
4234 Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
4235 you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
4236 Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
4240 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4242 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4243 @cindex describing groups
4244 @cindex group description
4245 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4246 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4247 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4251 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4252 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4253 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4260 @findex gnus-version
4261 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4265 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4266 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4269 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4272 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4273 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4277 @node Group Timestamp
4278 @subsection Group Timestamp
4280 @cindex group timestamps
4282 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4283 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4284 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4287 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4290 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4292 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4293 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4296 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4297 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4300 This will result in lines looking like:
4303 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4304 0: custom 19961002T012713
4307 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4308 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4312 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4313 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4316 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4317 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4321 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4322 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4323 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4324 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4326 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4332 @subsection File Commands
4333 @cindex file commands
4339 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4340 @vindex gnus-init-file
4341 @cindex reading init file
4342 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4343 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4347 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4348 @cindex saving .newsrc
4349 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4350 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4351 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4354 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4355 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4356 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4361 @node Sieve Commands
4362 @subsection Sieve Commands
4363 @cindex group sieve commands
4365 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4366 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4367 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4368 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4369 script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
4371 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4372 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4373 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4374 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4375 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4376 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4377 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4378 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4379 regenerate the Sieve script.
4381 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4382 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4383 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4384 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4385 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4386 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4387 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4388 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4389 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4390 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4393 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4394 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4399 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4405 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4406 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4407 @cindex generating sieve script
4408 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4409 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4413 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4414 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4415 @cindex updating sieve script
4416 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4417 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4418 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4423 @node Summary Buffer
4424 @chapter Summary Buffer
4425 @cindex summary buffer
4427 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4428 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4430 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4431 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4433 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4436 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4437 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4438 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4439 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4440 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4441 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4442 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4443 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4444 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4445 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4446 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4447 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4448 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4449 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4450 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4451 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4452 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4453 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4454 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4455 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4456 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4457 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4458 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4459 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4460 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4461 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4462 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4463 or reselecting the current group.
4464 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4465 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4466 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4467 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4471 @node Summary Buffer Format
4472 @section Summary Buffer Format
4473 @cindex summary buffer format
4477 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4478 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4479 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4485 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4486 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4487 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4488 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4491 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4492 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4493 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4494 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4495 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4496 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4497 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4498 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4499 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4500 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4501 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4504 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4505 'mail-extract-address-components)
4508 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4509 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4510 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4511 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4514 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4515 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4517 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4518 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4519 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4520 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4521 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4523 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4524 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4525 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4526 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4527 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4528 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4530 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4532 The following format specification characters and extended format
4533 specification(s) are understood:
4539 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4540 @code{gnus-list-identifies}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4542 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4543 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4544 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4546 Full @code{From} header.
4548 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4550 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4553 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4554 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4555 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4556 may be more thorough.
4558 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4561 Number of lines in the article.
4563 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4564 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4566 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4567 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4569 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4571 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4572 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4585 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4586 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4587 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4588 line-drawing glyphs.
4590 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4591 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4592 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4593 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4595 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4596 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4597 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4598 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4600 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4601 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4602 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4603 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4605 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4606 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4607 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4609 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4610 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4611 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4613 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4614 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4615 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4617 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4618 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4619 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4624 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4625 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4627 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4628 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4630 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4631 for adopted articles.
4633 One space for each thread level.
4635 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4637 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4640 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4641 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4642 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4645 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4647 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4648 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4649 default level. If the difference between
4650 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4651 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4659 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4661 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4667 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4668 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4670 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4671 article has any children.
4677 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4678 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4680 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4681 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4682 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4683 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4684 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4685 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4688 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4689 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4690 There can only be one such area.
4692 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4693 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4694 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4695 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4696 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4697 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4699 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4700 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4702 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4705 @node To From Newsgroups
4706 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4710 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4711 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4712 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4713 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4714 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4718 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4719 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4720 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4724 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4725 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4728 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4729 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4732 @findex gnus-extra-header
4733 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4734 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4735 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4738 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4742 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4743 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4744 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4745 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4746 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4747 headers are used instead.
4751 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4752 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4753 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
4754 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
4755 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
4756 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
4759 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4760 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4761 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4762 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4764 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
4768 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4770 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4771 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4772 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
4773 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4777 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
4780 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
4781 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
4784 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4785 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4786 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
4792 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4793 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4796 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4797 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4799 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4800 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4801 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4802 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4804 Here are the elements you can play with:
4810 Unprefixed group name.
4812 Current article number.
4814 Current article score.
4818 Number of unread articles in this group.
4820 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4823 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4824 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4825 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4826 and no unselected ones.
4828 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4829 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4831 Subject of the current article.
4833 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4835 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4837 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4839 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4841 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4843 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4847 @node Summary Highlighting
4848 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4852 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4853 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4854 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4855 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4856 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4858 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4859 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4860 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4861 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4863 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4864 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4865 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4866 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4868 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4869 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4870 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4871 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4872 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4873 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4876 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4877 ((> score default) . bold))
4879 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4880 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4884 @node Summary Maneuvering
4885 @section Summary Maneuvering
4886 @cindex summary movement
4888 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4889 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4891 None of these commands select articles.
4896 @kindex M-n (Summary)
4897 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
4898 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4899 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4900 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4904 @kindex M-p (Summary)
4905 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
4906 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4907 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
4908 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4911 @kindex G g (Summary)
4912 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
4913 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
4914 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
4917 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
4918 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
4919 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
4920 to the group buffer.
4922 Variables related to summary movement:
4926 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
4927 @item gnus-auto-select-next
4928 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
4929 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
4930 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
4931 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
4932 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
4933 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
4934 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
4935 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
4936 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
4937 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
4938 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
4939 @pxref{Group Levels}.
4941 @item gnus-auto-select-same
4942 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
4943 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
4944 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
4945 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
4946 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
4947 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
4949 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
4951 @item gnus-summary-check-current
4952 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
4953 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
4954 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
4955 Instead, they will choose the current article.
4957 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
4958 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
4959 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
4960 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
4961 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
4962 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
4963 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
4964 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
4967 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
4968 the given number of lines from the top.
4973 @node Choosing Articles
4974 @section Choosing Articles
4975 @cindex selecting articles
4978 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
4979 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
4983 @node Choosing Commands
4984 @subsection Choosing Commands
4986 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
4987 and they all select and display an article.
4989 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
4990 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
4994 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
4995 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
4996 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
4997 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4999 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5000 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5001 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5006 @kindex G n (Summary)
5007 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5008 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5009 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5014 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5015 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5016 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5021 @kindex G N (Summary)
5022 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5023 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5028 @kindex G P (Summary)
5029 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5030 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5033 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5034 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5035 Go to the next article with the same subject
5036 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5039 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5040 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5041 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5042 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5046 @kindex G f (Summary)
5048 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5049 Go to the first unread article
5050 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5054 @kindex G b (Summary)
5056 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5057 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5058 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5059 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5064 @kindex G l (Summary)
5065 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5066 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5069 @kindex G o (Summary)
5070 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5072 @cindex article history
5073 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5074 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5075 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5076 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5077 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5078 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5083 @kindex G j (Summary)
5084 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5085 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5086 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5091 @node Choosing Variables
5092 @subsection Choosing Variables
5094 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5097 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5098 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5099 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5100 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5101 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5102 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5104 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5105 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5106 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5107 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5108 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5111 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5112 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5113 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5114 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5115 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5116 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5117 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5118 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5119 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5120 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5121 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5122 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5123 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5124 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5129 @node Paging the Article
5130 @section Scrolling the Article
5131 @cindex article scrolling
5136 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5137 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5138 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5139 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5140 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5142 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5143 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5144 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5145 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5146 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5147 what is considered uninteresting with
5148 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5149 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5152 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5153 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5154 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5157 @kindex RET (Summary)
5158 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5159 Scroll the current article one line forward
5160 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5163 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5164 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5165 Scroll the current article one line backward
5166 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5170 @kindex A g (Summary)
5172 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5173 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5174 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5175 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
5176 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
5177 the way it came from the server.
5179 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5180 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5181 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5184 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5189 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5194 @kindex A < (Summary)
5195 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5196 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5197 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5202 @kindex A > (Summary)
5203 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5204 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5208 @kindex A s (Summary)
5210 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5211 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5212 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5216 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5217 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5222 @node Reply Followup and Post
5223 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5226 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5227 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5228 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5229 * Canceling and Superseding::
5233 @node Summary Mail Commands
5234 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5236 @cindex composing mail
5238 Commands for composing a mail message:
5244 @kindex S r (Summary)
5246 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5247 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5248 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5249 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5250 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5255 @kindex S R (Summary)
5256 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5257 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5258 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5259 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5260 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5263 @kindex S w (Summary)
5264 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5265 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5266 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5267 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5268 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5269 present, that's used instead.
5272 @kindex S W (Summary)
5273 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5274 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5275 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5276 the process/prefix convention.
5279 @kindex S v (Summary)
5280 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5281 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5282 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5283 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5284 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5285 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5288 @kindex S V (Summary)
5289 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5290 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5291 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5292 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5295 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5296 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5297 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5298 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5299 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5300 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5301 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5302 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5305 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5306 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5307 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5308 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5309 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5313 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5314 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5315 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5316 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5317 Forward the current article to some other person
5318 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5319 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5320 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5321 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5322 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5323 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5324 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5325 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5326 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5332 @kindex S m (Summary)
5333 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5334 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5335 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5336 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5337 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5342 @kindex S i (Summary)
5343 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5344 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5345 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5346 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5348 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5349 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5350 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5351 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5352 for this to work though.
5355 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5356 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5357 @cindex bouncing mail
5358 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5359 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5360 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5361 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5362 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5363 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5364 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5365 very well fail, though.
5368 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5369 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5370 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5371 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5372 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5373 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5374 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5375 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5376 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5377 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5379 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5380 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5381 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5382 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5383 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5385 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5386 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5389 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5390 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5392 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5393 if it were a new message before resending.
5396 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5397 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5398 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5399 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5400 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5403 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5404 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5405 @cindex crossposting
5406 @cindex excessive crossposting
5407 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5408 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5410 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5411 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5412 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5413 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5414 command understands the process/prefix convention
5415 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5419 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5420 Manual}, for more information.
5423 @node Summary Post Commands
5424 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5426 @cindex composing news
5428 Commands for posting a news article:
5434 @kindex S p (Summary)
5435 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5436 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5437 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5438 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5439 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5444 @kindex S f (Summary)
5445 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5446 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5447 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5451 @kindex S F (Summary)
5453 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5454 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5455 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5456 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5457 process/prefix convention.
5460 @kindex S n (Summary)
5461 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5462 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5463 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5466 @kindex S N (Summary)
5467 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5468 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5469 message through mail and include the original message
5470 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5471 the process/prefix convention.
5474 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5475 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5476 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5477 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5478 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5479 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5480 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5481 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5482 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5483 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5484 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5485 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5486 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5489 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5490 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5492 @cindex making digests
5493 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5494 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command uses the
5495 process/prefix convention.
5498 @kindex S u (Summary)
5499 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5500 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5501 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5502 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5505 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5506 Manual}, for more information.
5509 @node Summary Message Commands
5510 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5514 @kindex S y (Summary)
5515 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5516 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5517 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5518 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5519 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5524 @node Canceling and Superseding
5525 @subsection Canceling Articles
5526 @cindex canceling articles
5527 @cindex superseding articles
5529 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5530 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5532 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5534 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5536 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5537 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5538 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5539 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5540 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5541 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5543 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5544 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5547 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5548 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5549 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5551 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5552 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5553 message, Message Manual}).
5555 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5556 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5557 your original article.
5559 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5561 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5562 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5563 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5566 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5567 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5568 have posted almost the same article twice.
5570 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5571 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5572 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5573 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5574 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5575 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5576 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5577 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5578 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5579 canceled/superseded.
5581 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5583 @node Delayed Articles
5584 @section Delayed Articles
5585 @cindex delayed sending
5586 @cindex send delayed
5588 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5589 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5590 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5591 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5594 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5597 @findex gnus-delay-article
5598 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5599 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5600 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5601 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5605 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5606 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5607 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5608 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5611 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5612 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5613 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5616 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5617 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5618 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5619 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5620 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5621 that means a time tomorrow.
5624 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5625 couple of variables:
5628 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5629 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5630 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5631 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5633 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5634 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5635 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5636 formats described above.
5638 @item gnus-delay-group
5639 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5640 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5641 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5642 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5644 @item gnus-delay-header
5645 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5646 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5647 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5648 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5651 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5652 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5653 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5654 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5655 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5657 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5658 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5659 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5660 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5661 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5662 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5663 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5666 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5667 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5668 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5669 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5670 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5671 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5672 argument is ignored.
5674 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5675 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5676 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5680 @node Marking Articles
5681 @section Marking Articles
5682 @cindex article marking
5683 @cindex article ticking
5686 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5688 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5689 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5690 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5692 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5695 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5699 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5700 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
5701 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
5702 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
5703 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
5704 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
5708 @node Unread Articles
5709 @subsection Unread Articles
5711 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
5716 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
5717 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
5719 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
5720 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
5721 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
5722 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
5723 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
5724 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
5725 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
5728 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
5729 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
5731 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
5732 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
5733 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
5734 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
5738 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
5739 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
5741 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
5746 @subsection Read Articles
5747 @cindex expirable mark
5749 All the following marks mark articles as read.
5754 @vindex gnus-del-mark
5755 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
5756 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
5759 @vindex gnus-read-mark
5760 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
5763 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
5764 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
5765 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
5768 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
5769 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
5772 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
5773 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
5776 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
5777 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
5780 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
5781 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
5784 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
5785 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
5788 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
5789 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
5792 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
5793 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
5797 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
5798 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
5799 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
5803 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
5804 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
5806 One more special mark, though:
5810 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
5811 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
5813 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
5814 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
5815 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
5816 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
5822 @subsection Other Marks
5823 @cindex process mark
5826 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
5832 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
5833 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
5834 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
5835 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
5836 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
5839 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
5840 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
5841 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
5842 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
5845 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
5846 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
5847 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
5850 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
5851 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
5852 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5855 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
5856 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
5857 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
5858 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
5861 @vindex gnus-recent-mark
5862 Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
5863 before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
5864 (@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
5865 mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
5866 @code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
5869 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
5870 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
5871 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
5872 Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
5875 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
5876 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
5877 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
5878 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
5879 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
5883 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
5884 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
5885 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
5886 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
5887 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
5888 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
5891 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
5892 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
5893 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
5894 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
5895 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
5896 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
5900 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
5901 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
5902 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
5903 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
5904 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
5907 @vindex gnus-process-mark
5908 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
5909 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
5910 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
5911 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
5912 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
5916 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
5917 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
5918 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
5920 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
5921 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
5922 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
5926 @subsection Setting Marks
5927 @cindex setting marks
5929 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
5934 @kindex M c (Summary)
5935 @kindex M-u (Summary)
5936 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
5937 @cindex mark as unread
5938 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
5939 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
5945 @kindex M t (Summary)
5946 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
5947 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
5948 @xref{Article Caching}.
5953 @kindex M ? (Summary)
5954 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
5955 Mark the current article as dormant
5956 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5960 @kindex M d (Summary)
5962 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
5963 Mark the current article as read
5964 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
5968 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
5969 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
5970 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
5975 @kindex M k (Summary)
5976 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
5977 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
5978 and then select the next unread article
5979 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
5983 @kindex M K (Summary)
5984 @kindex C-k (Summary)
5985 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
5986 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
5987 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
5990 @kindex M C (Summary)
5991 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
5992 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
5993 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
5996 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
5997 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
5998 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
5999 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6002 @kindex M H (Summary)
6003 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6004 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6005 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6008 @kindex M h (Summary)
6009 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6010 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6011 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6014 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6015 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6016 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6017 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6020 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6021 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6022 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6023 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6027 @kindex M e (Summary)
6029 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6030 Mark the current article as expirable
6031 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6034 @kindex M b (Summary)
6035 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6036 Set a bookmark in the current article
6037 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6040 @kindex M B (Summary)
6041 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6042 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6043 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6046 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6047 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6048 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6049 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6052 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6053 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6054 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6055 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6058 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6059 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6060 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6061 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6062 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6065 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6066 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6067 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6068 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6069 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6070 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6071 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6072 The default is @code{t}.
6075 @node Generic Marking Commands
6076 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6078 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6079 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6080 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6081 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6082 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6085 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6086 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6089 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6090 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6091 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6092 to list in this manual.
6094 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6095 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6096 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6097 article, you could say something like:
6101 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6102 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6103 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6111 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6112 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6116 @node Setting Process Marks
6117 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6118 @cindex setting process marks
6120 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6121 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6122 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6123 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6124 commands into the cache. For more information,
6125 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6132 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6133 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6134 Mark the current article with the process mark
6135 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6136 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6140 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6141 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6142 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6143 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6146 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6147 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6148 Remove the process mark from all articles
6149 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6152 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6153 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6154 Invert the list of process marked articles
6155 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6158 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6159 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6160 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6161 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6164 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6165 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6166 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6167 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6170 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6171 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6172 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6175 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6176 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6177 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6180 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6181 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6182 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6183 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6186 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6187 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6188 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6189 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6192 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6193 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6194 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6195 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6198 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6199 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6200 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6203 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6204 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6205 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6206 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6209 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6210 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6211 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6214 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6215 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6216 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6217 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6220 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6221 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6222 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6223 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6226 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6227 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6228 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6229 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6232 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6233 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6234 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6235 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6239 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6240 set process marks based on article body contents.
6247 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6248 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6249 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6252 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
6253 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
6254 additional articles.
6260 @kindex / / (Summary)
6261 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6262 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6263 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6267 @kindex / a (Summary)
6268 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6269 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6270 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6274 @kindex / x (Summary)
6275 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6276 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6277 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6278 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6283 @kindex / u (Summary)
6285 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6286 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6287 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6288 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6289 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6292 @kindex / m (Summary)
6293 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6294 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6295 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6298 @kindex / t (Summary)
6299 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6300 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6301 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6302 articles younger than that number of days.
6305 @kindex / n (Summary)
6306 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6307 Limit the summary buffer to the current article
6308 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}). Uses the process/prefix
6309 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6312 @kindex / w (Summary)
6313 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6314 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6315 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6319 @kindex / . (Summary)
6320 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6321 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6322 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6325 @kindex / v (Summary)
6326 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6327 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6328 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6331 @kindex / p (Summary)
6332 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6333 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6334 group parameter predicate
6335 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6336 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6340 @kindex M S (Summary)
6341 @kindex / E (Summary)
6342 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6343 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6344 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6347 @kindex / D (Summary)
6348 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6349 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6350 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6353 @kindex / * (Summary)
6354 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6355 Include all cached articles in the limit
6356 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6359 @kindex / d (Summary)
6360 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6361 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6362 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6365 @kindex / M (Summary)
6366 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6367 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6370 @kindex / T (Summary)
6371 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6372 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6375 @kindex / c (Summary)
6376 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6377 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6378 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6381 @kindex / C (Summary)
6382 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6383 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6384 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6385 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6388 @kindex / N (Summary)
6389 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6390 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6391 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6394 @kindex / o (Summary)
6395 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6396 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6397 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6405 @cindex article threading
6407 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6408 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6409 hierarchical fashion.
6411 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6412 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6413 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6414 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6415 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6416 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6417 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6419 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6423 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6426 A tree-like article structure.
6429 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6432 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6433 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6434 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6435 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6436 called loose threads.
6438 @item thread gathering
6439 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6441 @item sparse threads
6442 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6443 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6449 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6450 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6454 @node Customizing Threading
6455 @subsection Customizing Threading
6456 @cindex customizing threading
6459 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6460 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6461 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6462 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6467 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6470 @cindex loose threads
6473 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6474 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6475 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6476 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6477 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6478 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6480 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6481 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6482 There are four possible values:
6486 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6487 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6488 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6489 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6490 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6495 @cindex adopting articles
6500 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6501 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6502 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6503 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6506 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6507 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6508 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6509 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6510 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6511 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6512 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6513 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6514 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6515 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6518 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6519 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6520 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6524 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6525 display them after one another.
6528 Don't gather loose threads.
6531 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6532 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6533 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6534 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6535 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6536 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6537 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6538 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6539 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6540 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6541 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6543 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6544 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6545 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6548 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6549 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6550 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6551 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6552 simplification is used.
6554 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6555 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6556 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6557 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6559 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6561 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6567 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6568 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6569 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6570 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6575 (mapconcat 'identity
6576 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6578 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6581 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6584 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6585 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6586 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6587 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6588 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6589 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6591 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6594 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6595 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6596 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6598 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6599 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6602 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6603 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6604 Remove excessive whitespace.
6606 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6607 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6608 Remove all whitespace.
6611 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6614 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6615 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6616 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6617 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6618 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6619 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6620 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6621 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6623 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6624 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6625 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6626 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6627 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6628 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6629 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6630 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6631 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6635 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6636 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6637 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6638 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6640 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6641 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6642 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6645 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6649 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6650 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6656 @node Filling In Threads
6657 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6660 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6661 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6662 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6663 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
6664 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
6665 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
6666 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
6667 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
6668 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
6669 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
6670 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
6671 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
6674 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
6675 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
6676 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
6678 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6679 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6680 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
6683 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
6684 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
6685 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
6686 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
6687 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
6688 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
6689 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
6690 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
6691 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
6692 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
6693 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
6694 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
6695 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
6696 @code{nil} by default.
6698 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
6699 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
6700 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
6701 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
6702 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
6703 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
6704 web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
6706 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
6707 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
6708 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
6713 @node More Threading
6714 @subsubsection More Threading
6717 @item gnus-show-threads
6718 @vindex gnus-show-threads
6719 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
6720 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
6721 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
6722 slower and more awkward.
6724 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6725 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6726 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
6729 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
6730 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
6731 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
6736 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6737 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
6738 gnus-article-unseen-p))
6741 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
6742 unread, but you get my drift.)
6745 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
6746 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
6747 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
6748 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
6749 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
6750 threads are expunged.
6752 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
6753 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
6754 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
6757 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6758 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6759 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
6760 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
6761 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
6762 result in a new thread.
6764 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
6765 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
6766 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
6769 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6770 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6771 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
6772 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
6773 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
6774 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
6775 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
6776 Setting this variable to an alternate value
6777 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
6778 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
6779 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
6784 @node Low-Level Threading
6785 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
6789 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
6790 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
6791 Hook run before parsing any headers.
6793 @item gnus-alter-header-function
6794 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
6795 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
6796 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
6797 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
6798 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
6799 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
6800 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
6801 meaningful. Here's one example:
6804 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
6806 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
6807 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
6809 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
6811 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
6818 @node Thread Commands
6819 @subsection Thread Commands
6820 @cindex thread commands
6826 @kindex T k (Summary)
6827 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
6828 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
6829 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
6830 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
6831 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
6836 @kindex T l (Summary)
6837 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
6838 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
6839 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
6840 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
6843 @kindex T i (Summary)
6844 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
6845 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
6846 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
6849 @kindex T # (Summary)
6850 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6851 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
6852 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6855 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
6856 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6857 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
6858 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6861 @kindex T T (Summary)
6862 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
6863 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
6866 @kindex T s (Summary)
6867 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
6868 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
6869 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
6872 @kindex T h (Summary)
6873 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
6874 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
6877 @kindex T S (Summary)
6878 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
6879 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
6882 @kindex T H (Summary)
6883 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
6884 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
6887 @kindex T t (Summary)
6888 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
6889 Re-thread the current article's thread
6890 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
6891 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
6894 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
6895 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
6896 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
6897 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
6901 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
6902 understand the numeric prefix.
6907 @kindex T n (Summary)
6909 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
6911 @kindex M-down (Summary)
6912 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
6913 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
6916 @kindex T p (Summary)
6918 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
6920 @kindex M-up (Summary)
6921 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
6922 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
6925 @kindex T d (Summary)
6926 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
6927 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
6930 @kindex T u (Summary)
6931 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
6932 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
6935 @kindex T o (Summary)
6936 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
6937 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
6940 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
6941 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
6942 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
6943 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
6944 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
6945 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
6946 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
6947 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
6948 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
6949 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
6950 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
6951 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
6955 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
6956 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
6958 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
6959 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
6960 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
6961 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
6962 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
6963 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6964 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
6965 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
6966 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
6967 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
6968 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
6969 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
6970 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
6971 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
6973 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
6974 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
6975 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
6976 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
6977 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
6978 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
6979 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
6980 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
6982 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
6983 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
6984 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
6986 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
6987 last function in the list. You should probably always include
6988 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
6989 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
6990 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
6991 ascending article order.
6993 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
6994 by number, you could do something like:
6997 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
6998 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6999 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7000 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7003 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7004 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7005 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7006 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7007 which the articles arrived.
7009 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7013 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7015 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
7016 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7019 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7020 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7021 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7022 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7025 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7026 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7027 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7028 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7029 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7030 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7031 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7032 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7033 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7034 variable. It is very similar to the
7035 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7036 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7037 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7038 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7039 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7040 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7041 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7043 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7047 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7048 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7049 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7054 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7055 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7056 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7057 @cindex article pre-fetch
7060 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7061 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7062 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7063 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7064 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7066 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7067 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7069 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7070 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7071 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7072 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7073 connection is blocked.
7075 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7076 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7077 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7078 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7080 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7081 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7082 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7083 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7086 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7089 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7090 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7091 happen automatically.
7093 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7094 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7095 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7096 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7097 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7098 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7099 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7101 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7102 @findex gnus-async-read-p
7103 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7104 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7105 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7106 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7107 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-read-p}, which
7108 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7109 article data structure as the only parameter.
7111 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7112 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7115 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7116 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7117 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7118 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7121 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7124 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7125 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7126 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7128 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7129 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7130 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7131 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7135 Remove articles when they are read.
7138 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7141 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7143 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7144 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7145 @c from the next group.
7148 @node Article Caching
7149 @section Article Caching
7150 @cindex article caching
7153 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7154 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7155 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7156 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7157 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7159 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7161 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7162 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7163 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7164 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7165 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7166 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7167 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7168 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7170 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7171 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7172 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7173 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7174 as dormant, and don't worry.
7176 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7178 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7179 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7180 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7181 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7182 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7183 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7184 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7185 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7186 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7187 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7189 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7190 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7191 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7192 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7193 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7194 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7195 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7196 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7197 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7198 not then be downloaded by this command.
7200 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7201 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7202 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7203 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7204 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7205 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7207 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7208 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7209 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7210 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7211 variables, the group is not cached.
7213 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7214 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7215 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7216 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7217 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7218 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7219 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7220 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7221 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7224 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7225 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7226 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7227 where, isn't that cool?
7229 @node Persistent Articles
7230 @section Persistent Articles
7231 @cindex persistent articles
7233 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7234 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7235 useful in my opinion.
7237 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7238 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7239 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7240 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7241 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7242 the expiry going on at the news server.
7244 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7245 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7246 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7252 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7253 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7256 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7257 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7258 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7259 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7263 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7265 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7266 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7267 interested in persistent articles:
7270 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7274 @node Article Backlog
7275 @section Article Backlog
7277 @cindex article backlog
7279 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7280 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7281 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7282 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7283 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7284 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7285 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7286 increase memory usage some.
7288 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7289 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7290 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7291 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7292 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7293 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7294 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7296 The default value is 20.
7299 @node Saving Articles
7300 @section Saving Articles
7301 @cindex saving articles
7303 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7304 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7305 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7306 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7307 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7309 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7310 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7311 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7313 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7314 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7315 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7317 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7318 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7319 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7320 deleted before saving.
7326 @kindex O o (Summary)
7328 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7329 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7330 Save the current article using the default article saver
7331 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7334 @kindex O m (Summary)
7335 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7336 Save the current article in mail format
7337 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7340 @kindex O r (Summary)
7341 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7342 Save the current article in Rmail format
7343 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
7346 @kindex O f (Summary)
7347 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7348 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7349 Save the current article in plain file format
7350 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7353 @kindex O F (Summary)
7354 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7355 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7356 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7359 @kindex O b (Summary)
7360 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7361 Save the current article body in plain file format
7362 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7365 @kindex O h (Summary)
7366 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7367 Save the current article in mh folder format
7368 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7371 @kindex O v (Summary)
7372 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7373 Save the current article in a VM folder
7374 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7378 @kindex O p (Summary)
7380 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7381 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7382 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7383 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7384 complete headers in the piped output.
7387 @kindex O P (Summary)
7388 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7389 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7390 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7391 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7392 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7393 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7394 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7398 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7399 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7400 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7401 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7402 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7403 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7404 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7405 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7406 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7407 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7408 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7409 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7413 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7414 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7415 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the six ready-made
7416 functions below, or you can create your own.
7420 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7421 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7422 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7423 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7424 This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
7425 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7426 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7428 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7429 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7430 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7431 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7432 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7433 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7435 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7436 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7437 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7438 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7439 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7440 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7441 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7443 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7444 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7445 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7446 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7447 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7448 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7450 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7451 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7452 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7453 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7454 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7456 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7457 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7458 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7459 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7460 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7463 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7464 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7465 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7466 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7467 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7469 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7470 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7471 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7472 reader to use this setting.
7475 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7476 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7477 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7478 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7481 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7482 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7483 available functions that generate names:
7487 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7488 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7489 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7491 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7492 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7493 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7495 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7496 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7497 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7499 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7500 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7501 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7503 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7504 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7505 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7508 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7509 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7510 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7511 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7512 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7516 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7517 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7518 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7519 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7522 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
7523 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
7524 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
7525 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
7526 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
7527 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
7528 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
7529 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
7530 called returns a string or a list of strings.
7532 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
7533 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
7534 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
7535 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
7537 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
7538 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
7539 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
7542 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
7543 lots of mail groups called things like
7544 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
7545 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
7546 following will do just that:
7549 (defun my-save-name (group)
7550 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
7551 (substring group (match-end 0))))
7553 (setq gnus-split-methods
7554 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
7559 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7560 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
7561 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
7562 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
7563 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
7564 all the files in the top level directory
7565 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
7566 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
7567 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
7568 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
7570 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
7571 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
7572 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
7573 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
7574 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
7577 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
7581 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
7582 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
7583 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
7586 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
7587 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
7588 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
7589 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
7592 @node Decoding Articles
7593 @section Decoding Articles
7594 @cindex decoding articles
7596 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
7597 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
7600 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
7601 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
7602 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
7603 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
7604 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
7605 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
7609 @cindex article series
7610 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
7611 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
7612 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
7613 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
7614 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
7616 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
7617 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
7618 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
7620 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
7621 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
7622 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
7624 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
7625 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
7626 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
7629 @node Uuencoded Articles
7630 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
7632 @cindex uuencoded articles
7637 @kindex X u (Summary)
7638 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
7639 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
7640 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
7643 @kindex X U (Summary)
7644 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
7645 Uudecodes and saves the current series
7646 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7649 @kindex X v u (Summary)
7650 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
7651 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
7654 @kindex X v U (Summary)
7655 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
7656 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
7657 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
7661 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
7662 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
7663 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
7664 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
7665 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7667 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
7668 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
7669 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
7670 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
7673 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
7674 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
7675 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
7676 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
7677 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
7678 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
7682 @node Shell Archives
7683 @subsection Shell Archives
7685 @cindex shell archives
7686 @cindex shared articles
7688 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
7689 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
7690 some commands to deal with these:
7695 @kindex X s (Summary)
7696 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
7697 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
7700 @kindex X S (Summary)
7701 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
7702 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
7705 @kindex X v s (Summary)
7706 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
7707 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
7710 @kindex X v S (Summary)
7711 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
7712 Unshars, views and saves the current series
7713 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
7717 @node PostScript Files
7718 @subsection PostScript Files
7724 @kindex X p (Summary)
7725 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
7726 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
7729 @kindex X P (Summary)
7730 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
7731 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
7732 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
7735 @kindex X v p (Summary)
7736 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
7737 View the current PostScript series
7738 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
7741 @kindex X v P (Summary)
7742 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
7743 View and save the current PostScript series
7744 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
7749 @subsection Other Files
7753 @kindex X o (Summary)
7754 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
7755 Save the current series
7756 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
7759 @kindex X b (Summary)
7760 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
7761 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
7762 doesn't really work yet.
7766 @node Decoding Variables
7767 @subsection Decoding Variables
7769 Adjective, not verb.
7772 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
7773 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
7774 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
7778 @node Rule Variables
7779 @subsubsection Rule Variables
7780 @cindex rule variables
7782 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
7783 variables are of the form
7786 (list '(regexp1 command2)
7793 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7794 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7796 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
7797 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
7800 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7801 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
7804 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7805 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7806 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
7807 user and default view rules.
7809 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7810 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7811 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
7816 @node Other Decode Variables
7817 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
7820 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7822 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7823 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
7824 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
7825 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
7826 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
7830 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
7831 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
7834 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
7835 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
7836 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
7839 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7840 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7841 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
7842 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
7843 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
7846 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7847 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7848 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
7850 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7851 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7852 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
7853 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
7854 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
7857 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7858 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7859 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
7861 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7862 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7863 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
7864 looking for files to display.
7866 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
7867 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
7868 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
7871 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7872 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7873 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
7876 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7877 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7878 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
7881 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7882 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7883 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
7886 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7887 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7888 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
7889 decoded articles as unread.
7891 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7892 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7893 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
7894 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
7896 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7897 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7898 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
7900 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7901 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7903 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
7904 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
7905 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
7906 @code{metamail} for viewing.
7908 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7909 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7910 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
7911 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
7912 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
7913 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
7914 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
7915 simply dropped them.
7920 @node Uuencoding and Posting
7921 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
7925 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7926 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7927 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
7928 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
7929 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
7930 for you when you post the article.
7932 @item gnus-uu-post-length
7933 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
7934 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
7935 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
7937 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
7938 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
7939 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
7940 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
7941 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
7942 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
7943 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
7945 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7946 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7947 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
7948 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
7949 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
7950 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
7951 Default is @code{t}.
7957 @subsection Viewing Files
7958 @cindex viewing files
7959 @cindex pseudo-articles
7961 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
7962 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
7963 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
7964 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
7965 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
7966 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
7967 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
7969 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
7970 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
7971 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
7972 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
7974 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
7975 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
7976 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
7978 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
7979 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
7980 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
7981 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
7982 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
7984 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
7985 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
7986 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
7987 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
7988 a list of parameters to that command.
7990 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
7991 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
7992 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
7994 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
7995 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
7996 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
7999 @node Article Treatment
8000 @section Article Treatment
8002 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8003 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8004 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8005 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8006 these articles easier.
8009 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8010 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8011 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8012 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8013 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8014 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8015 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8016 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8017 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
8018 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8019 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8023 @node Article Highlighting
8024 @subsection Article Highlighting
8025 @cindex highlighting
8027 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8028 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8033 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8034 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8035 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8036 Do much highlighting of the current article
8037 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8038 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8041 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8042 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8043 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8044 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8045 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8046 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8047 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8048 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8049 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8050 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8051 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8052 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8055 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8056 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8057 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8059 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8062 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8064 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8065 If the article size if bigger than this variable (which is 25000 by
8066 default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8068 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8069 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8070 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8072 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8073 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8074 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8075 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8076 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8077 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8079 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8080 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8081 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8083 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8084 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8085 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8087 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8088 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8089 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8090 that it's a citation.
8092 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8093 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8094 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8096 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8097 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8098 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8100 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8101 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8102 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8103 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8105 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8106 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8107 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8108 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8109 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8116 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8117 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8118 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8119 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8120 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8121 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8122 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8123 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8128 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8131 @node Article Fontisizing
8132 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8134 @cindex article emphasis
8136 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8137 @kindex W e (Summary)
8138 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8139 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8140 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8141 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8143 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8144 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8145 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8146 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8147 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8148 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8149 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8150 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8154 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8155 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8156 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8165 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8166 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8167 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8168 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8169 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8170 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8171 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8172 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8173 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8174 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8175 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8176 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8177 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8179 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8180 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8181 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8185 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8188 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8190 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8191 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8192 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8193 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8195 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8198 @node Article Hiding
8199 @subsection Article Hiding
8200 @cindex article hiding
8202 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8203 too much cruft in most articles.
8208 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8209 @findex gnus-article-hide
8210 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8211 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8212 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8215 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8216 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8217 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8221 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8222 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8223 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8224 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8227 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8228 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8229 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8233 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8234 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8235 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8236 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8237 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8238 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8239 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8240 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8244 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8245 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8246 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8247 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8252 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8253 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8254 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8255 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8258 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8259 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8260 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8261 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8264 @cindex stripping advertisements
8265 @cindex advertisements
8266 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8267 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8268 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8269 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8270 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8271 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8272 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8273 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8274 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8275 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8278 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8279 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8280 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8284 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8285 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8286 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8287 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8288 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8289 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8290 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8291 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8292 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8293 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8294 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8297 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8298 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8304 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8305 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8306 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8307 customizing the hiding:
8311 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8312 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8313 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8314 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8315 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8316 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8317 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8322 Starting point of the hidden text.
8324 Ending point of the hidden text.
8326 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8328 Number of lines of hidden text.
8331 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8332 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8333 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8334 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8335 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8340 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8341 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8343 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8344 following two variables:
8347 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8348 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8349 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8350 50), hide the cited text.
8352 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8353 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8354 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8359 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8360 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8361 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8362 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8363 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8364 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8368 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8369 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8370 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8372 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8373 citation customization.
8375 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8379 @node Article Washing
8380 @subsection Article Washing
8382 @cindex article washing
8384 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8385 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8387 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8388 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8391 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8392 articles by default.
8397 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8398 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8402 Force redisplaying of the current article
8403 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8404 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8405 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8406 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8409 @kindex W l (Summary)
8410 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8411 Remove page breaks from the current article
8412 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8416 @kindex W r (Summary)
8417 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8418 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8419 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8420 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8421 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8422 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8424 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8425 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8426 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8427 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8430 @kindex W m (Summary)
8431 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8432 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8436 @kindex W t (Summary)
8438 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8439 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8440 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8443 @kindex W v (Summary)
8444 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8445 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8446 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8449 @kindex W o (Summary)
8450 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8451 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8454 @kindex W d (Summary)
8455 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8456 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8458 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8460 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8461 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8462 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8463 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8466 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8467 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8468 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8469 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8472 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8473 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8474 @cindex Outlook Express
8475 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8476 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8477 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8480 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8481 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8482 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8483 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8484 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8485 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
8486 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
8487 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
8488 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
8489 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
8492 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
8493 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
8494 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
8495 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
8498 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
8499 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
8500 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
8501 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
8504 @kindex W w (Summary)
8505 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
8506 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
8508 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
8512 @kindex W Q (Summary)
8513 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
8514 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
8517 @kindex W C (Summary)
8518 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
8519 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
8520 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
8523 @kindex W c (Summary)
8524 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
8525 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8526 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
8527 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
8528 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
8531 @kindex W q (Summary)
8532 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
8533 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
8534 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
8535 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
8536 makes strings like @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which
8537 doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually done
8538 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8539 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8540 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8543 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
8544 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
8545 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
8546 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
8547 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
8548 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8549 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8550 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8553 @kindex W Z (Summary)
8554 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
8555 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
8556 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
8557 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
8560 @kindex W u (Summary)
8561 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
8562 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
8563 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
8564 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
8565 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
8568 @kindex W h (Summary)
8569 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
8570 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
8571 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8572 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
8574 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8576 @vindex gnus-article-wash-function
8577 The default is to use the function specified by
8578 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
8579 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
8580 @acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
8581 @code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
8589 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
8592 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
8595 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
8598 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
8603 @kindex W b (Summary)
8604 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
8605 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
8606 @xref{Article Buttons}.
8609 @kindex W B (Summary)
8610 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
8611 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
8612 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
8615 @kindex W p (Summary)
8616 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
8617 Verify a signed control message
8618 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
8619 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
8620 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
8621 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
8622 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
8623 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
8626 @kindex W s (Summary)
8627 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
8628 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
8629 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
8630 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
8633 @kindex W a (Summary)
8634 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
8635 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
8636 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
8639 @kindex W E l (Summary)
8640 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
8641 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
8642 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
8645 @kindex W E m (Summary)
8646 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
8647 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
8648 lines with a single empty line.
8649 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
8652 @kindex W E t (Summary)
8653 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
8654 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
8655 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
8658 @kindex W E a (Summary)
8659 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
8660 Do all the three commands above
8661 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
8664 @kindex W E A (Summary)
8665 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
8666 Remove all blank lines
8667 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
8670 @kindex W E s (Summary)
8671 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
8672 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
8673 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
8676 @kindex W E e (Summary)
8677 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
8678 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
8679 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
8683 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
8686 @node Article Header
8687 @subsection Article Header
8689 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
8694 @kindex W G u (Summary)
8695 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
8696 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
8699 @kindex W G n (Summary)
8700 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
8701 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
8702 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
8705 @kindex W G f (Summary)
8706 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
8707 Fold all the message headers
8708 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
8711 @kindex W E w (Summary)
8712 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
8713 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
8714 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
8719 @node Article Buttons
8720 @subsection Article Buttons
8723 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
8724 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
8725 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
8726 button on these references.
8728 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8729 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
8730 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
8731 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
8732 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
8736 @item gnus-button-alist
8737 @vindex gnus-button-alist
8738 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
8741 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8747 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
8748 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
8749 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
8750 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
8751 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
8754 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
8755 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
8756 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
8759 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
8760 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
8761 avoid false matches. Often variables named
8762 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
8763 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
8765 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
8768 This function will be called when you click on this button.
8771 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
8772 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
8776 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
8779 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
8782 @item gnus-header-button-alist
8783 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
8784 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
8785 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
8786 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
8789 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8792 @var{header} is a regular expression.
8795 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
8798 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
8799 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
8801 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
8803 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
8804 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
8805 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
8806 default values of the variables above.
8808 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
8810 @item gnus-button-man-handler
8811 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8812 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
8813 argument with a string naming the man page.
8815 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
8817 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8818 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8819 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
8821 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8822 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8823 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
8824 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
8825 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
8826 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
8827 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
8828 @code{ask}, always query the user what do do. If it is a function, this
8829 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
8830 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
8831 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
8832 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8834 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8835 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8836 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
8837 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
8838 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
8841 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8842 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8843 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
8844 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8846 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
8848 @item gnus-button-ctan-handler
8849 @findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
8850 The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
8851 argument, the string naming the URL.
8854 @vindex gnus-ctan-url
8855 Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
8856 by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
8860 @item gnus-article-button-face
8861 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
8862 Face used on buttons.
8864 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
8865 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
8866 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
8870 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
8873 @node Article Button Levels
8874 @subsection Article button levels
8875 @cindex button levels
8876 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
8877 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
8878 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
8879 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
8880 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
8881 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
8882 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
8883 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
8886 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
8887 (setq gnus-parameters
8888 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
8889 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
8890 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
8895 @item gnus-button-browse-level
8896 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
8897 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
8898 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
8899 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
8900 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
8902 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
8903 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
8904 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
8905 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
8906 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
8907 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
8908 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
8909 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
8910 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
8911 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
8912 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
8913 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
8914 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
8916 @item gnus-button-man-level
8917 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
8918 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
8919 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
8921 @item gnus-button-message-level
8922 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
8923 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
8924 Related variables and functions include
8925 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
8926 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
8927 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
8928 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
8930 @item gnus-button-tex-level
8931 @vindex gnus-button-tex-level
8932 Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
8933 URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
8934 @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
8935 @code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
8936 @code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
8942 @subsection Article Date
8944 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
8945 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
8946 when the article was sent.
8951 @kindex W T u (Summary)
8952 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
8953 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
8954 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
8957 @kindex W T i (Summary)
8958 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
8960 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
8961 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
8964 @kindex W T l (Summary)
8965 @findex gnus-article-date-local
8966 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
8969 @kindex W T p (Summary)
8970 @findex gnus-article-date-english
8971 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
8972 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
8975 @kindex W T s (Summary)
8976 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
8977 @findex gnus-article-date-user
8978 @findex format-time-string
8979 Display the date using a user-defined format
8980 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
8981 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
8982 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
8983 for a list of possible format specs.
8986 @kindex W T e (Summary)
8987 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
8988 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
8989 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
8990 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
8991 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
8994 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
8997 @vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
8998 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
8999 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
9002 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
9003 into wonderful absurdities.
9005 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
9008 (gnus-start-date-timer)
9011 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
9012 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
9016 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9017 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9018 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9019 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9020 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9021 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9022 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9026 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9027 preferred format automatically.
9030 @node Article Display
9031 @subsection Article Display
9036 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9037 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9039 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9040 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9042 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9043 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9045 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9046 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9048 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9049 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9051 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9056 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9057 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9058 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9059 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9062 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9063 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9064 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9065 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9068 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9069 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9070 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9073 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9074 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9075 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9078 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9079 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9080 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9081 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9084 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9085 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9086 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9087 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9090 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9091 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9092 Remove all images from the article buffer
9093 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9099 @node Article Signature
9100 @subsection Article Signature
9102 @cindex article signature
9104 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9105 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9106 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9107 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9108 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9109 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9110 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9111 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9112 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9115 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9116 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9117 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9118 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9119 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9120 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9121 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9122 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9125 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9128 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9129 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9130 signature when displaying articles.
9134 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9137 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9140 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9141 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9143 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9144 in question is not a signature.
9147 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9148 listed above. Here's an example:
9151 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9152 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9155 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9156 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9157 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9158 signature after all.
9161 @node Article Miscellanea
9162 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9166 @kindex A t (Summary)
9167 @findex gnus-article-babel
9168 Translate the article from one language to another
9169 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9175 @section MIME Commands
9176 @cindex MIME decoding
9178 @cindex viewing attachments
9180 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9181 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9187 @kindex K v (Summary)
9188 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9191 @kindex K o (Summary)
9192 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9195 @kindex K c (Summary)
9196 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9199 @kindex K e (Summary)
9200 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9203 @kindex K i (Summary)
9204 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9207 @kindex K | (Summary)
9208 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9211 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9216 @kindex K b (Summary)
9217 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9218 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9222 @kindex K m (Summary)
9223 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9224 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9225 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9226 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9227 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9230 @kindex X m (Summary)
9231 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9232 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9233 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9234 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9237 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9238 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9239 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9240 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9243 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9244 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9245 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9246 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9249 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9250 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9251 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9252 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9254 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9255 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9256 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9257 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9258 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9259 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9262 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9263 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9264 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9265 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9272 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9273 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9274 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9275 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9278 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9281 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9285 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9286 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9287 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9288 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9289 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9290 default is @code{nil}.
9292 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9293 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9294 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9295 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9296 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9297 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9298 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}.
9300 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9301 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9302 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9303 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9304 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9305 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9306 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9307 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9309 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9310 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9311 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9312 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9313 displayed. This variable overrides
9314 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9315 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9318 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9319 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9320 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9322 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9323 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9324 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9325 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9326 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9328 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9329 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9330 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9331 default value is @code{nil}.
9333 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9334 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9335 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9336 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9337 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9338 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9339 save all jpegs into some directory).
9341 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9344 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9345 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9347 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9348 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9349 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9350 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9351 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9354 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9355 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9356 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9358 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9359 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9360 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9362 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9363 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9364 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9366 If displaying "text/html" is discouraged, see
9367 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} in @ref{Display Customization,
9368 Display Customization, , emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}. Images or
9369 other material inside a "multipart/related" part might be overlooked
9370 when this variable is @code{nil}.
9372 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9373 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9374 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9375 overrides @code{nil} values of
9376 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9377 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9379 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9380 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9381 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9382 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9384 Ready-made functions include@*
9385 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9386 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9387 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9388 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9389 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9390 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9391 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9392 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9393 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9394 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9395 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9396 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9398 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9399 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9401 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9402 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9403 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9406 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9407 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9408 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9409 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9413 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9422 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9423 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9424 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9425 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9426 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9427 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9428 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
9430 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
9431 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
9432 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
9433 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
9435 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
9436 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
9437 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
9438 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
9439 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
9440 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
9441 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
9442 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
9443 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
9445 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
9446 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
9447 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
9448 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
9449 quoted-printable header encoding.
9451 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
9452 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
9453 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
9457 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
9460 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
9461 means encode all charsets),
9463 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
9464 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
9465 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
9472 @cindex coding system aliases
9473 @cindex preferred charset
9475 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
9476 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
9477 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
9479 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
9481 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
9482 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
9485 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
9486 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
9489 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
9490 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
9492 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
9495 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
9498 This will almost do the right thing.
9500 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
9504 (codepage-setup 1251)
9505 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
9509 @node Article Commands
9510 @section Article Commands
9517 @kindex A P (Summary)
9518 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
9519 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
9520 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
9521 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
9522 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
9523 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
9528 @node Summary Sorting
9529 @section Summary Sorting
9530 @cindex summary sorting
9532 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
9533 can't really see why you'd want that.
9538 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
9539 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
9540 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
9543 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
9544 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
9545 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
9548 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
9549 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
9550 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
9553 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
9554 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
9555 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
9558 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
9559 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
9560 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
9563 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
9564 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
9565 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
9568 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
9569 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
9570 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
9573 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
9574 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
9575 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
9578 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
9579 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
9580 Sort using the default sorting method
9581 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
9584 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
9585 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
9586 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
9587 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
9588 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
9592 @node Finding the Parent
9593 @section Finding the Parent
9594 @cindex parent articles
9595 @cindex referring articles
9600 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
9601 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
9602 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
9603 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
9604 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
9605 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
9606 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
9607 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
9608 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
9610 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
9611 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
9612 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
9613 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
9614 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
9618 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
9619 @kindex A R (Summary)
9620 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
9621 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
9624 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
9625 @kindex A T (Summary)
9626 Display the full thread where the current article appears
9627 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
9628 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
9629 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
9630 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
9631 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
9632 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
9634 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
9635 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
9636 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
9637 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
9638 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
9639 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
9642 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
9643 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
9645 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
9646 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
9647 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
9648 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
9649 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
9650 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
9652 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
9653 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
9654 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
9657 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
9658 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
9659 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
9660 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
9661 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
9662 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
9665 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
9666 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
9667 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
9670 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
9671 then ask Google if that fails:
9674 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
9676 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
9679 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
9680 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
9681 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
9682 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
9683 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
9684 group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
9685 not support this at all.
9688 @node Alternative Approaches
9689 @section Alternative Approaches
9691 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
9692 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
9695 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
9696 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
9701 @subsection Pick and Read
9702 @cindex pick and read
9704 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
9705 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
9706 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
9707 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
9709 @findex gnus-pick-mode
9710 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
9711 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
9712 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
9713 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
9714 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
9716 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
9721 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
9722 Pick the article or thread on the current line
9723 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9724 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
9725 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
9726 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
9727 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
9728 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
9731 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
9732 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
9733 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
9734 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
9738 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
9739 Unpick the thread or article
9740 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9741 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
9742 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
9743 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
9744 the thread or article at that line.
9748 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
9749 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
9750 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
9751 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
9752 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
9753 will still be visible when you are reading.
9757 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
9758 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
9759 which is mapped to the same function
9760 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
9762 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
9765 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
9768 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
9769 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
9771 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
9772 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
9773 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
9775 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
9776 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
9777 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
9778 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
9779 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
9780 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
9781 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
9785 @subsection Binary Groups
9786 @cindex binary groups
9788 @findex gnus-binary-mode
9789 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
9790 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
9791 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
9792 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
9793 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
9794 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
9797 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
9798 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
9799 command, when you have turned on this mode
9800 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
9802 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
9803 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
9807 @section Tree Display
9810 @vindex gnus-use-trees
9811 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
9812 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
9813 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
9816 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
9819 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
9820 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
9821 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
9823 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9824 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9825 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
9826 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
9827 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
9829 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
9830 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
9831 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
9832 default is @code{modeline}.
9834 @item gnus-tree-line-format
9835 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
9836 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
9837 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
9838 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
9839 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
9840 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
9846 The name of the poster.
9848 The @code{From} header.
9850 The number of the article.
9852 The opening bracket.
9854 The closing bracket.
9859 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
9861 Variables related to the display are:
9864 @item gnus-tree-brackets
9865 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
9866 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
9867 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
9869 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
9870 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
9871 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
9873 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
9875 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9876 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9877 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
9878 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
9882 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
9883 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
9884 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
9885 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
9886 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
9887 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
9888 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
9889 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
9890 other windows displayed next to it.
9892 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
9896 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
9897 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
9900 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
9901 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
9902 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9903 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
9904 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
9905 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
9906 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
9910 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
9913 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
9923 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
9928 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
9929 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
9931 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
9933 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
9939 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
9940 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
9941 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
9944 (setq gnus-use-trees t
9945 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9946 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
9947 (gnus-add-configuration
9951 (summary 0.75 point)
9956 @xref{Window Layout}.
9959 @node Mail Group Commands
9960 @section Mail Group Commands
9961 @cindex mail group commands
9963 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
9964 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
9966 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
9967 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9972 @kindex B e (Summary)
9973 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
9974 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
9975 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
9976 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
9977 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
9980 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
9981 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
9982 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
9983 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
9984 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
9985 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
9988 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
9989 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
9990 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
9991 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
9992 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
9993 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
9996 @kindex B m (Summary)
9998 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
9999 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10000 Move the article from one mail group to another
10001 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10002 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10005 @kindex B c (Summary)
10007 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10008 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10009 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10010 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10011 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10014 @kindex B B (Summary)
10015 @cindex crosspost mail
10016 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10017 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10018 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10019 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10020 be properly updated.
10023 @kindex B i (Summary)
10024 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10025 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10026 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10027 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10030 @kindex B I (Summary)
10031 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10032 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10033 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10034 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10037 @kindex B r (Summary)
10038 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10039 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10040 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10041 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10042 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10043 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10044 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10045 (which is the default).
10049 @kindex B w (Summary)
10050 @kindex e (Summary)
10051 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10052 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10053 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10054 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10055 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10056 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10057 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10060 @kindex B q (Summary)
10061 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10062 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10063 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10064 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10067 @kindex B t (Summary)
10068 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10069 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10070 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10073 @kindex B p (Summary)
10074 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10075 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10076 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10077 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10078 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10079 article from your news server (or rather, from
10080 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10081 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10082 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10083 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10084 just not have arrived yet.
10087 @kindex K E (Summary)
10088 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10089 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10090 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10091 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10092 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10096 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10097 @cindex moving articles
10098 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10099 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10100 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10101 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10102 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10103 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10104 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10107 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10108 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10109 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10110 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10114 @node Various Summary Stuff
10115 @section Various Summary Stuff
10118 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10119 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10120 * Summary Generation Commands::
10121 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10125 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10126 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10127 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10128 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10129 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10130 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10132 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10133 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10134 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10137 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10138 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10139 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10141 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10142 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10143 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10144 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10145 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10146 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10149 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10150 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10151 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10152 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10153 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10155 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10156 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10157 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10160 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10161 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10162 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10163 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10164 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10165 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10166 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10167 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10168 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10169 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10171 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10172 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10173 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10174 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10175 list of articles to be selected.
10177 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10178 the list in one particular group:
10181 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10182 (if (string= group "some.group")
10183 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10187 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10188 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10189 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10190 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10191 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10194 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10195 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10196 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10197 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10198 variable will be used instead.
10200 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10201 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10202 buffers. For example:
10205 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10206 '(message-use-followup-to
10207 (gnus-visible-headers .
10208 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10211 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10215 @node Summary Group Information
10216 @subsection Summary Group Information
10221 @kindex H f (Summary)
10222 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
10223 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
10224 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
10225 for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
10226 to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
10227 is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
10228 a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
10229 will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
10230 or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
10233 @kindex H d (Summary)
10234 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10235 Give a brief description of the current group
10236 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10237 rereading the description from the server.
10240 @kindex H h (Summary)
10241 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10242 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10243 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10246 @kindex H i (Summary)
10247 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10248 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10252 @node Searching for Articles
10253 @subsection Searching for Articles
10258 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10259 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10260 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10261 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10264 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10265 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10266 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10267 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10270 @kindex & (Summary)
10271 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10272 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10273 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10274 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10275 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10276 search backward instead.
10278 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10279 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10282 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10283 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10284 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10285 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10288 @node Summary Generation Commands
10289 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10294 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10295 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10296 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10299 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10300 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10301 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10302 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10305 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10306 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10307 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10308 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10313 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10314 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10320 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10321 @kindex A D (Summary)
10322 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10323 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10324 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10325 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10326 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10327 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10328 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10329 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10333 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10334 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10335 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10336 several documents into one biiig group
10337 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10338 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10339 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10340 command understands the process/prefix convention
10341 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10344 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10345 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10346 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10347 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10348 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10349 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10352 @kindex = (Summary)
10353 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10354 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10355 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10358 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10359 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10360 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10361 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10364 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10365 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10366 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10367 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
10372 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
10373 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
10374 @cindex summary exit
10375 @cindex exiting groups
10377 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
10378 group and return you to the group buffer.
10385 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
10386 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
10387 @kindex q (Summary)
10388 @findex gnus-summary-exit
10389 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
10390 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
10391 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
10392 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
10393 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
10394 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
10395 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
10396 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
10397 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
10398 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
10399 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
10403 @kindex Z E (Summary)
10404 @kindex Q (Summary)
10405 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
10406 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
10407 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
10411 @kindex Z c (Summary)
10412 @kindex c (Summary)
10413 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
10414 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
10415 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
10416 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
10419 @kindex Z C (Summary)
10420 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
10421 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
10422 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
10425 @kindex Z n (Summary)
10426 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
10427 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
10428 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
10432 @kindex Z R (Summary)
10433 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
10434 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
10435 Exit this group, and then enter it again
10436 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
10437 all articles, both read and unread.
10441 @kindex Z G (Summary)
10442 @kindex M-g (Summary)
10443 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
10444 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
10445 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
10446 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
10447 articles, both read and unread.
10450 @kindex Z N (Summary)
10451 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
10452 Exit the group and go to the next group
10453 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
10456 @kindex Z P (Summary)
10457 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
10458 Exit the group and go to the previous group
10459 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
10462 @kindex Z s (Summary)
10463 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
10464 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
10465 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
10466 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
10467 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
10470 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
10471 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
10472 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
10473 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
10475 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
10476 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
10477 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
10478 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
10479 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
10480 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
10481 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
10482 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
10483 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
10484 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
10485 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
10486 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
10488 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
10490 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
10491 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
10492 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
10493 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
10494 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
10495 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
10496 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
10497 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
10498 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
10501 @node Crosspost Handling
10502 @section Crosspost Handling
10506 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
10507 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
10508 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
10509 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
10510 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
10511 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
10514 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
10515 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
10516 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
10517 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
10518 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
10520 @cindex cross-posting
10522 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
10523 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
10524 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
10525 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
10526 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
10527 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
10528 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
10529 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
10530 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
10531 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
10532 the cross reference mechanism.
10534 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
10535 @cindex overview.fmt
10536 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
10537 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
10538 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
10539 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
10540 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
10541 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
10544 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
10545 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
10546 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
10551 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
10554 @node Duplicate Suppression
10555 @section Duplicate Suppression
10557 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
10558 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
10559 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
10560 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
10565 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
10566 is evil and not very common.
10569 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
10570 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
10573 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
10574 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
10577 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
10580 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
10581 well, but these four are the most common situations.
10583 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
10584 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
10585 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
10586 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
10587 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
10588 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
10589 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
10592 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
10593 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
10594 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
10595 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
10596 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
10597 saw the article in.
10600 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
10601 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
10602 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
10604 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
10605 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
10606 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
10607 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
10608 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
10609 session are suppressed.
10611 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
10612 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
10613 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
10614 suppression list. The default is 10000.
10616 @item gnus-duplicate-file
10617 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
10618 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
10619 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
10622 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
10623 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
10624 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
10625 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
10626 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
10627 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
10628 to you to figure out, I think.
10633 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
10634 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
10635 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
10640 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
10641 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
10642 to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
10643 Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
10646 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
10647 or newer is recommended.
10651 More information on how to set things up can be found in the message
10652 manual (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
10655 @item mm-verify-option
10656 @vindex mm-verify-option
10657 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
10658 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
10659 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10661 @item mm-decrypt-option
10662 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
10663 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
10664 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
10665 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10668 @vindex mml1991-use
10669 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10670 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10671 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10675 @vindex mml2015-use
10676 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10677 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10678 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10683 @cindex snarfing keys
10684 @cindex importing PGP keys
10685 @cindex PGP key ring import
10686 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
10687 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
10688 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
10689 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
10690 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
10691 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
10692 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
10693 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
10694 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
10697 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
10700 This happens to also be the default action defined in
10701 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
10704 @section Mailing List
10705 @cindex mailing list
10708 @kindex A M (summary)
10709 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
10710 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
10711 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
10712 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
10715 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
10720 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
10721 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
10722 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
10725 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
10726 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
10727 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
10730 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
10731 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
10732 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
10736 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
10737 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
10738 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
10741 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
10742 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10743 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
10746 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
10747 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10748 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
10753 @node Article Buffer
10754 @chapter Article Buffer
10755 @cindex article buffer
10757 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
10758 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
10759 tell Gnus otherwise.
10762 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
10763 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
10764 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
10765 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
10766 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
10770 @node Hiding Headers
10771 @section Hiding Headers
10772 @cindex hiding headers
10773 @cindex deleting headers
10775 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
10776 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
10778 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
10779 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
10780 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
10781 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
10782 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
10783 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
10784 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
10785 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
10786 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
10788 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
10792 @item gnus-visible-headers
10793 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
10794 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
10795 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
10796 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
10798 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
10799 the article and the subject, you'd say:
10802 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
10805 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10808 @item gnus-ignored-headers
10809 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
10810 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
10811 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
10812 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
10813 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
10815 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
10816 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
10819 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
10822 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10825 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
10826 variable will have no effect.
10830 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
10831 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
10832 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
10833 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
10834 the headers are to be displayed.
10836 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
10837 and then the subject, you might say something like:
10840 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
10843 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
10844 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
10846 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
10847 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
10848 You can hide further boring headers by setting
10849 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
10850 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
10851 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
10852 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
10855 These conditions are:
10858 Remove all empty headers.
10860 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
10861 @code{Newsgroups} header.
10863 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
10864 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
10867 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
10870 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10871 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
10873 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10874 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10876 Remove the @code{CC} header if it only contains the address identical to
10877 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10879 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
10882 Remove the @code{To} header if it is very long.
10884 Remove all @code{To} headers if there are more than one.
10887 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
10890 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
10891 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
10894 This is also the default value for this variable.
10898 @section Using MIME
10899 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
10901 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
10902 while people stand around yawning.
10904 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
10905 while all newsreaders die of fear.
10907 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
10908 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
10909 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
10911 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
10912 @findex gnus-display-mime
10913 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
10914 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
10915 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
10916 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
10918 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
10919 @acronym{MIME} button:
10922 @findex gnus-article-press-button
10923 @item RET (Article)
10924 @kindex RET (Article)
10925 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
10926 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
10927 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
10928 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
10929 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
10930 object is displayed inline.
10932 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
10933 @item M-RET (Article)
10934 @kindex M-RET (Article)
10936 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
10937 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
10939 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
10941 @kindex t (Article)
10942 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
10943 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
10945 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
10947 @kindex C (Article)
10948 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
10949 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
10951 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
10953 @kindex o (Article)
10954 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
10955 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
10957 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
10958 @item C-o (Article)
10959 @kindex C-o (Article)
10960 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
10961 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
10962 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
10963 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
10964 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
10965 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
10967 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
10969 @kindex d (Article)
10970 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
10971 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
10972 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
10974 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
10976 @kindex c (Article)
10977 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
10978 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
10979 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
10980 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
10981 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
10983 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
10985 @kindex p (Article)
10986 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
10987 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
10988 @file{.mailcap} file.
10990 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
10992 @kindex i (Article)
10993 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
10994 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
10995 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
10996 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
10997 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11000 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11002 @kindex E (Article)
11003 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11004 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11005 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11007 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11009 @kindex e (Article)
11010 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11011 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11013 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11015 @kindex | (Article)
11016 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11018 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11020 @kindex . (Article)
11021 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11022 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11026 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11027 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11028 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11030 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11031 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11032 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11033 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11034 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11035 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11036 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11037 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11038 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11040 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11042 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11045 @node Customizing Articles
11046 @section Customizing Articles
11047 @cindex article customization
11049 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11050 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11051 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11052 called automatically when you select the articles.
11054 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11055 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11056 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11057 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11059 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11060 for sensible values.
11064 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11067 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11070 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11073 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
11076 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11080 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11081 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11082 regexps in the list.
11085 A list where the first element is not a string:
11087 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11088 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11089 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11093 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11098 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11099 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11100 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11101 considered to contain just a single part.
11103 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11104 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11105 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11106 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11107 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11108 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11109 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11111 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11112 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11113 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11114 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11117 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11118 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11120 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11122 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11123 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11124 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11125 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11126 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
11127 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11128 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11129 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11130 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11131 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11133 @xref{Article Washing}.
11135 @item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
11136 @item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
11137 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
11138 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
11139 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
11140 @item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
11141 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
11143 @xref{Article Date}.
11145 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11146 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11147 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11151 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11153 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11155 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11156 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11157 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11161 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11165 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11169 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
11170 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
11171 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
11172 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
11173 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
11174 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
11175 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
11176 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
11177 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
11178 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
11180 @xref{Article Hiding}.
11182 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
11183 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
11184 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
11186 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
11188 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
11189 @item gnus-treat-translate
11190 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
11192 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
11193 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
11194 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
11195 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
11197 @xref{Article Header}.
11202 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
11203 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
11204 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
11205 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
11206 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
11210 @node Article Keymap
11211 @section Article Keymap
11213 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
11214 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
11215 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
11216 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
11219 A few additional keystrokes are available:
11224 @kindex SPACE (Article)
11225 @findex gnus-article-next-page
11226 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
11227 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
11230 @kindex DEL (Article)
11231 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
11232 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
11233 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
11236 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
11237 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
11238 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
11239 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
11240 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
11243 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
11244 @findex gnus-article-mail
11245 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
11246 given a prefix, include the mail.
11249 @kindex s (Article)
11250 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
11251 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
11252 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
11255 @kindex ? (Article)
11256 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
11257 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
11258 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
11261 @kindex TAB (Article)
11262 @findex gnus-article-next-button
11263 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
11264 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
11267 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
11268 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
11269 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
11272 @kindex R (Article)
11273 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
11274 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
11275 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If given a prefix, make a
11276 wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11280 @kindex F (Article)
11281 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
11282 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
11283 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If given a prefix, make
11284 a wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11292 @section Misc Article
11296 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
11297 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
11298 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
11299 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
11302 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
11303 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
11304 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11305 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
11306 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
11308 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
11309 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
11310 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
11311 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
11312 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
11313 the contents of the article buffer.
11315 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
11316 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
11317 Hook called in article mode buffers.
11319 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11320 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11321 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
11322 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
11324 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
11325 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
11326 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
11327 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
11329 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
11330 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
11331 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
11332 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
11333 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
11334 with two extensions:
11339 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
11340 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
11341 performed. The characters and their meaning:
11346 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
11349 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
11352 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
11353 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
11354 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
11357 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
11360 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
11363 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
11368 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
11372 @vindex gnus-break-pages
11374 @item gnus-break-pages
11375 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
11376 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
11377 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
11378 paging will not be done.
11380 @item gnus-page-delimiter
11381 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
11382 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
11386 @cindex internationalized domain names
11387 @vindex gnus-use-idna
11388 @item gnus-use-idna
11389 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
11390 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
11391 @samp{Cc} headers. This requires
11392 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
11393 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
11398 @node Composing Messages
11399 @chapter Composing Messages
11400 @cindex composing messages
11403 @cindex sending mail
11408 @cindex using s/mime
11409 @cindex using smime
11411 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
11412 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
11413 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
11414 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
11415 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
11416 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
11419 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
11420 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
11421 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
11422 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
11423 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
11424 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
11425 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
11426 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
11427 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
11430 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
11431 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
11437 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
11440 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
11441 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
11442 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
11443 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
11444 @code{nil} include all headers.
11446 @item gnus-add-to-list
11447 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
11448 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
11449 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
11451 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11452 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11453 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
11454 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
11455 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
11456 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
11457 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
11458 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
11460 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
11461 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
11463 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11464 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11465 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
11466 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
11467 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
11472 @node Posting Server
11473 @section Posting Server
11475 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
11476 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
11478 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
11480 It can be quite complicated.
11482 @vindex gnus-post-method
11483 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
11484 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
11485 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
11486 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
11487 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
11488 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
11489 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
11490 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
11491 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
11494 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
11497 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
11498 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
11499 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
11500 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
11502 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
11503 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
11505 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
11506 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
11509 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
11510 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
11512 When sending mail, Message invokes @code{message-send-mail-function}.
11513 The default function, @code{message-send-mail-with-sendmail}, pipes
11514 your article to the @code{sendmail} binary for further queuing and
11515 sending. When your local system is not configured for sending mail
11516 using @code{sendmail}, and you have access to a remote @acronym{SMTP}
11517 server, you can set @code{message-send-mail-function} to
11518 @code{smtpmail-send-it} and make sure to setup the @code{smtpmail}
11519 package correctly. An example:
11522 (setq message-send-mail-function 'smtpmail-send-it
11523 smtpmail-default-smtp-server "YOUR SMTP HOST")
11526 To the thing similar to this, there is
11527 @code{message-smtpmail-send-it}. It is useful if your @acronym{ISP}
11528 requires the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication.
11529 @xref{POP before SMTP}.
11531 Other possible choices for @code{message-send-mail-function} includes
11532 @code{message-send-mail-with-mh}, @code{message-send-mail-with-qmail},
11533 and @code{feedmail-send-it}.
11535 @node POP before SMTP
11536 @section POP before SMTP
11537 @cindex pop before smtp
11538 @findex message-smtpmail-send-it
11539 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
11541 Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
11542 authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
11543 mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
11544 a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
11545 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11548 (setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
11549 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
11553 It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
11554 whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
11555 does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
11556 @code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
11557 Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
11558 @code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
11559 set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
11560 correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
11562 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
11563 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
11564 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
11565 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
11566 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
11567 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
11570 (setq mail-source-primary-source
11571 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11572 :password "secret"))
11576 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
11577 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
11580 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
11582 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
11583 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11584 :password "secret")))
11585 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
11588 @node Mail and Post
11589 @section Mail and Post
11591 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
11595 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
11596 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
11597 @cindex mailing lists
11599 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
11600 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
11601 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
11602 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
11603 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
11604 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
11605 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
11606 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
11607 still a pain, though.
11609 @item gnus-user-agent
11610 @vindex gnus-user-agent
11613 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
11614 User-Agent header. It can be one of the symbols @code{gnus} (show only
11615 Gnus version), @code{emacs-gnus} (show only Emacs and Gnus versions),
11616 @code{emacs-gnus-config} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus system
11617 configuration), @code{emacs-gnus-type} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus
11618 system type) or a custom string. If you set it to a string, be sure to
11619 use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
11623 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
11624 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
11625 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
11628 @findex ispell-message
11630 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
11633 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
11634 you're in, you could say something like the following:
11637 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
11641 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
11642 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
11644 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
11647 Modify to suit your needs.
11650 @node Archived Messages
11651 @section Archived Messages
11652 @cindex archived messages
11653 @cindex sent messages
11655 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
11656 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
11657 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
11658 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
11661 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
11662 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
11665 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
11666 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
11667 use to store sent messages. The default is:
11670 (nnfolder "archive"
11671 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
11672 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
11673 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
11674 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
11677 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
11678 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
11679 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
11680 directory chosen, you could say something like:
11683 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
11684 '(nnfolder "archive"
11685 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
11686 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
11687 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
11690 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
11692 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
11693 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
11694 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
11696 This variable can be used to do the following:
11700 Messages will be saved in that group.
11702 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
11703 message will not be stored in the select method given by
11704 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
11705 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
11706 has the default value shown above. Then setting
11707 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
11708 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
11709 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
11712 @item a list of strings
11713 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
11715 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
11716 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
11719 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
11724 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
11726 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
11729 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
11731 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
11734 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
11736 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11737 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
11738 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
11739 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
11742 More complex stuff:
11744 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11745 '((if (message-news-p)
11750 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
11751 messages in one file per month:
11754 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11755 '((if (message-news-p)
11757 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
11760 @c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
11761 @c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
11763 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
11764 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
11765 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
11766 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
11767 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
11768 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
11769 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
11770 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
11771 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
11772 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
11774 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
11775 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
11776 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
11777 this will disable archiving.
11780 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
11781 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
11782 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
11783 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
11784 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
11787 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
11788 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
11789 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
11792 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
11793 but the latter is the preferred method.
11795 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11796 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11797 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
11799 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11800 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11801 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
11802 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
11803 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
11804 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
11805 changed in the future.
11810 @node Posting Styles
11811 @section Posting Styles
11812 @cindex posting styles
11815 All them variables, they make my head swim.
11817 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
11818 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
11819 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
11822 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
11823 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
11824 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
11825 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
11826 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
11831 (signature "Peace and happiness")
11832 (organization "What me?"))
11834 (signature "Death to everybody"))
11835 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
11836 (organization "Emacs is it")))
11839 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
11840 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
11841 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
11842 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
11843 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
11844 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
11845 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
11846 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
11848 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
11849 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
11850 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
11851 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
11852 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
11853 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
11854 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
11855 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
11856 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
11857 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
11858 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
11859 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
11860 said to @dfn{match}.
11862 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
11863 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
11864 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
11865 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
11866 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
11867 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
11868 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
11869 name can be one of:
11872 @item @code{signature}
11873 @item @code{signature-file}
11874 @item @code{x-face-file}
11875 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
11876 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
11880 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
11881 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
11882 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
11883 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
11884 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
11886 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
11887 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
11888 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
11889 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
11890 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
11891 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
11892 is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
11893 references chars lines xref extra.
11895 @vindex message-reply-headers
11897 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
11898 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
11899 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
11901 @findex message-mail-p
11902 @findex message-news-p
11904 So here's a new example:
11907 (setq gnus-posting-styles
11909 (signature-file "~/.signature")
11911 ("X-Home-Page" (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
11912 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
11914 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
11915 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
11916 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
11917 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
11918 (signature my-news-signature))
11919 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
11920 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
11921 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
11922 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
11923 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
11924 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
11925 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
11926 (address "user@@bar.foo")
11927 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
11928 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
11930 (From (save-excursion
11931 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
11932 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
11934 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
11937 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
11938 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
11939 if you fill many roles.
11946 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
11947 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
11948 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
11949 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
11950 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
11952 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
11953 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
11954 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
11955 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
11956 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
11960 @vindex nndraft-directory
11961 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
11962 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
11963 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
11964 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
11965 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
11966 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
11968 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
11969 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
11970 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
11971 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
11972 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
11973 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
11974 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
11975 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
11976 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
11978 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
11979 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
11980 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
11981 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
11982 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
11983 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
11984 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
11985 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
11986 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
11987 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
11988 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
11989 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
11990 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
11991 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
11993 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
11994 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
11995 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
11997 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
11998 @kindex D e (Draft)
11999 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12000 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12001 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12003 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12006 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12007 @kindex D s (Draft)
12008 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12009 @kindex D S (Draft)
12010 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12011 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12012 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12013 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12014 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12017 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12018 @kindex D t (Draft)
12019 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12020 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12021 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12024 @node Rejected Articles
12025 @section Rejected Articles
12026 @cindex rejected articles
12028 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12029 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12030 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12031 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12033 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12034 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12035 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12036 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12037 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12039 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12040 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12041 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12043 @node Signing and encrypting
12044 @section Signing and encrypting
12046 @cindex using s/mime
12047 @cindex using smime
12049 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12050 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12051 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12052 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12054 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12055 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12056 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12057 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12058 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12059 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12060 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12061 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12062 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12063 automatically encrypted messages.
12065 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12066 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12067 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12072 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12073 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12075 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12078 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12079 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12081 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12084 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12085 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12087 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12090 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12091 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12093 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12096 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12097 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
12099 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12102 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
12103 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
12105 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12108 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
12109 @findex mml-unsecure-message
12110 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
12114 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
12116 @node Select Methods
12117 @chapter Select Methods
12118 @cindex foreign groups
12119 @cindex select methods
12121 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
12122 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
12123 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
12124 personal mail group.
12126 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
12127 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
12128 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
12129 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
12130 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
12131 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
12133 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
12134 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
12136 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
12139 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
12140 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
12141 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
12142 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
12143 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
12145 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
12148 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
12149 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
12150 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
12151 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
12152 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
12153 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
12154 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
12155 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
12159 @node Server Buffer
12160 @section Server Buffer
12162 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
12163 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
12164 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
12165 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
12166 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
12167 back end represents a virtual server.
12169 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
12170 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
12171 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
12172 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
12174 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
12175 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
12176 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
12177 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
12178 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
12179 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
12180 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
12182 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
12183 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
12186 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
12187 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
12188 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
12189 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
12190 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
12191 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
12192 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
12195 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
12196 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
12199 @node Server Buffer Format
12200 @subsection Server Buffer Format
12201 @cindex server buffer format
12203 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
12204 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
12205 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
12206 variable, with some simple extensions:
12211 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
12214 The name of this server.
12217 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
12220 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
12223 Whether this server is agentized.
12226 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
12227 The mode line can also be customized by using the
12228 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
12229 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
12239 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
12242 @node Server Commands
12243 @subsection Server Commands
12244 @cindex server commands
12250 @findex gnus-server-add-server
12251 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
12255 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
12256 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
12259 @kindex SPACE (Server)
12260 @findex gnus-server-read-server
12261 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
12265 @findex gnus-server-exit
12266 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
12270 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
12271 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
12275 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
12276 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
12280 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
12281 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
12285 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
12286 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
12290 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
12291 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
12292 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
12297 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
12298 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
12299 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
12300 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
12305 @node Example Methods
12306 @subsection Example Methods
12308 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
12311 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
12314 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
12320 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
12321 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
12324 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
12325 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
12327 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
12328 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
12332 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
12335 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
12336 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
12338 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
12339 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
12340 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
12344 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
12347 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
12350 Here's the method for a public spool:
12354 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
12355 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
12361 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
12362 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
12363 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12364 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
12365 should probably look something like this:
12369 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
12370 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
12371 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host")
12372 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12375 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
12376 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
12377 configuration to the example above:
12380 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
12383 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}.
12385 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
12386 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
12387 telnet connection to the news server as follows:
12391 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12392 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-telnet)
12393 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
12394 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12397 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
12398 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
12399 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
12400 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
12403 @node Creating a Virtual Server
12404 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
12406 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
12407 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
12409 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
12410 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
12411 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
12413 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
12415 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
12416 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
12417 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
12418 will contain the following:
12428 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
12429 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
12432 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
12433 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
12434 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
12437 @node Server Variables
12438 @subsection Server Variables
12439 @cindex server variables
12440 @cindex server parameters
12442 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
12443 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
12444 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
12445 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
12446 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
12448 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
12449 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
12450 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
12451 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
12452 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
12453 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
12454 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
12455 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
12456 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
12460 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
12461 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
12462 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
12465 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
12467 @node Servers and Methods
12468 @subsection Servers and Methods
12470 Wherever you would normally use a select method
12471 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
12472 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
12473 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
12477 @node Unavailable Servers
12478 @subsection Unavailable Servers
12480 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
12481 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
12482 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
12483 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
12484 actually the case or not.
12486 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
12487 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
12488 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
12489 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
12490 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
12491 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
12492 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
12493 it will regard that server as ``down''.
12495 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
12496 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
12498 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
12499 with the following commands:
12505 @findex gnus-server-open-server
12506 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
12507 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
12511 @findex gnus-server-close-server
12512 Close the connection (if any) to the server
12513 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
12517 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
12518 Mark the current server as unreachable
12519 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
12522 @kindex M-o (Server)
12523 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
12524 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
12525 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
12528 @kindex M-c (Server)
12529 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
12530 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
12531 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
12535 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
12536 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
12537 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
12541 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
12542 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
12548 @section Getting News
12549 @cindex reading news
12550 @cindex news back ends
12552 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
12553 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
12554 or it can read from a local spool.
12557 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12558 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
12566 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
12567 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
12568 server as the, uhm, address.
12570 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
12571 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
12572 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
12573 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12575 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
12576 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
12577 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
12579 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
12584 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
12585 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
12586 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
12588 @cindex authentification
12589 @cindex nntp authentification
12590 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12591 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
12592 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
12593 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
12594 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
12595 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
12596 present in this hook.
12598 @item nntp-authinfo-function
12599 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
12600 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12601 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
12602 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
12603 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
12604 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
12605 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
12606 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
12607 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
12608 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
12609 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
12613 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
12616 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
12618 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
12619 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
12620 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
12621 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
12622 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
12623 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
12624 @samp{force} is explained below.
12628 Here's an example file:
12631 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
12632 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
12635 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
12636 have to be first, for instance.
12638 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
12639 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
12640 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
12641 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
12642 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
12643 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
12644 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
12646 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
12647 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
12653 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
12654 previously mentioned.
12656 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
12658 @item nntp-server-action-alist
12659 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
12660 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
12661 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
12662 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
12665 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
12666 '(("innd" (ding))))
12669 You probably don't want to do that, though.
12671 The default value is
12674 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
12675 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
12676 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
12679 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
12680 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
12682 @item nntp-maximum-request
12683 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
12684 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
12685 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
12686 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
12687 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
12688 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
12689 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
12691 @item nntp-connection-timeout
12692 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
12693 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
12694 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
12695 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
12696 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
12697 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
12698 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
12699 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
12700 no timeouts are done.
12702 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
12703 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
12704 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
12705 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
12708 @item nntp-xover-commands
12709 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
12710 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
12712 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
12713 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
12717 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
12718 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
12719 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
12720 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
12721 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
12722 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
12723 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
12724 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
12725 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
12726 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
12727 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
12729 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
12730 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
12731 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12733 @item nntp-record-commands
12734 @vindex nntp-record-commands
12735 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
12736 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
12737 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
12738 that doesn't seem to work.
12740 @item nntp-open-connection-function
12741 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
12742 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
12743 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
12744 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
12745 Six pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped in
12746 two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
12747 indirect ones (two pre-made).
12749 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
12750 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
12751 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
12752 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
12753 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
12754 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
12755 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
12758 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
12761 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
12762 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
12767 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
12768 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
12769 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
12773 @node Direct Functions
12774 @subsubsection Direct Functions
12775 @cindex direct connection functions
12777 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
12778 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
12779 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
12780 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12783 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
12784 @item nntp-open-network-stream
12785 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
12788 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
12789 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
12790 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12791 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
12792 installed. You then define a server as follows:
12795 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12796 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
12798 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12799 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
12800 (nntp-port-number )
12801 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12804 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
12805 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
12806 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12807 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
12808 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
12809 then define a server as follows:
12812 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12813 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
12815 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12816 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
12817 (nntp-port-number 563)
12818 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12821 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
12822 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
12823 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server by simply @samp{telnet}'ing
12824 it. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have the
12825 default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
12826 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
12827 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
12828 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
12832 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12833 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
12834 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
12837 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
12838 session, which is not a good idea.
12842 @node Indirect Functions
12843 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
12844 @cindex indirect connection functions
12846 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
12847 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12848 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
12849 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
12850 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
12851 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12854 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12855 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12856 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet}
12857 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
12858 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
12860 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12863 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
12864 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
12865 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
12866 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
12868 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12869 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12870 List of strings to be used as the switches to
12871 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
12872 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
12873 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections, otherwise set
12874 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
12875 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
12879 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12880 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12881 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
12882 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
12884 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12887 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
12888 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
12889 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
12892 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
12893 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
12894 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
12895 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
12897 @item nntp-via-user-password
12898 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
12899 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
12901 @item nntp-via-envuser
12902 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
12903 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
12904 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
12905 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
12907 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
12908 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
12909 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
12910 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
12917 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
12922 @item nntp-via-user-name
12923 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
12924 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
12926 @item nntp-via-address
12927 @vindex nntp-via-address
12928 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
12933 @node Common Variables
12934 @subsubsection Common Variables
12936 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
12937 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
12938 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
12939 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
12940 variables individually).
12944 @item nntp-pre-command
12945 @vindex nntp-pre-command
12946 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
12947 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
12948 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
12949 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
12952 @vindex nntp-address
12953 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12955 @item nntp-port-number
12956 @vindex nntp-port-number
12957 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
12958 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
12959 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
12960 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
12961 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
12962 not work with named ports.
12964 @item nntp-end-of-line
12965 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
12966 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
12967 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
12968 using a non native connection function.
12970 @item nntp-telnet-command
12971 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
12972 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
12973 @samp{telnet}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
12974 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
12977 @item nntp-telnet-switches
12978 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
12979 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-telnet-command}. The default
12986 @subsection News Spool
12990 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
12991 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
12992 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
12995 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
12996 anything else) as the address.
12998 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
12999 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
13000 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
13001 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
13005 @item nnspool-inews-program
13006 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
13007 Program used to post an article.
13009 @item nnspool-inews-switches
13010 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
13011 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
13013 @item nnspool-spool-directory
13014 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
13015 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
13016 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
13018 @item nnspool-nov-directory
13019 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
13020 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
13021 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
13023 @item nnspool-lib-dir
13024 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
13025 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
13027 @item nnspool-active-file
13028 @vindex nnspool-active-file
13029 The name of the active file.
13031 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
13032 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
13033 The name of the group descriptions file.
13035 @item nnspool-history-file
13036 @vindex nnspool-history-file
13037 The name of the news history file.
13039 @item nnspool-active-times-file
13040 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
13041 The name of the active date file.
13043 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
13044 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
13045 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
13048 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13049 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13051 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
13052 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
13053 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
13060 @section Getting Mail
13061 @cindex reading mail
13064 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
13068 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
13069 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
13070 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
13071 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
13072 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
13073 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
13074 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
13075 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
13076 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
13077 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
13078 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
13079 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
13080 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
13084 @node Mail in a Newsreader
13085 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
13087 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
13088 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
13089 of a culture shock.
13091 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
13092 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
13094 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
13095 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
13096 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
13097 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
13099 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
13101 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
13102 deleted? How awful!
13104 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
13105 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
13106 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
13107 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
13110 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
13111 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
13112 they want to treat a message.
13114 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
13115 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
13116 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
13117 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
13118 archived somewhere else.
13120 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
13121 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
13122 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
13123 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
13124 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
13126 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
13127 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
13128 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
13130 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
13131 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
13134 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
13135 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
13136 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
13137 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
13138 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
13140 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
13141 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
13142 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
13143 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
13144 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
13145 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
13149 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
13150 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
13152 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
13153 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
13154 and things will happen automatically.
13156 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
13157 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13160 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
13163 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
13164 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
13165 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
13166 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
13167 like any other group.
13169 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
13172 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13173 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13174 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13178 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
13179 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
13180 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
13183 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
13184 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
13185 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
13188 @node Splitting Mail
13189 @subsection Splitting Mail
13190 @cindex splitting mail
13191 @cindex mail splitting
13192 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
13194 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
13195 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
13196 to be split into groups.
13199 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13200 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13201 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13202 ("mail.other" "")))
13205 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
13206 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
13207 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
13208 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
13209 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
13210 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
13211 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
13214 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
13218 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
13219 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
13221 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
13222 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
13223 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
13224 mail belongs in that group.
13226 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
13227 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
13228 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
13229 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
13230 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
13231 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
13232 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
13233 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
13234 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
13235 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
13237 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
13238 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
13239 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
13240 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
13241 thinks should carry this mail message.
13243 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
13244 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
13245 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
13246 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
13248 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
13249 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
13250 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
13251 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
13252 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
13254 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
13257 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
13258 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
13259 links. If that's the case for you, set
13260 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
13261 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
13263 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
13264 @findex nnmail-split-history
13265 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
13266 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
13267 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
13268 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
13271 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
13272 Header lines longer than the value of
13273 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
13276 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
13277 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
13278 By default the splitting codes @acronym{MIME} decodes headers so you
13279 can match on non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. The
13280 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset} variable specifies the default
13281 charset for decoding. The behavior can be turned off completely by
13282 binding @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} to @code{nil}, which is
13283 useful if you want to match articles based on the raw header data.
13285 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13286 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
13287 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
13288 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
13289 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
13290 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
13291 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
13292 other kinds of entries.)
13294 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
13295 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
13296 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
13297 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
13298 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
13299 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
13300 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
13301 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
13302 month's rent money.
13306 @subsection Mail Sources
13308 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
13309 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
13310 maildir, for instance.
13313 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
13314 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
13315 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
13319 @node Mail Source Specifiers
13320 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
13322 @cindex mail server
13325 @cindex mail source
13327 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
13328 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
13333 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
13336 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
13337 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
13338 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
13341 The following mail source types are available:
13345 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
13351 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
13352 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
13353 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
13357 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13360 An example file mail source:
13363 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
13366 Or using the default file name:
13372 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
13373 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
13374 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
13375 mail spool while moving the mail.
13377 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
13381 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
13384 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
13388 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
13391 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
13393 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
13396 Alter this script to fit find the @samp{movemail} you want to use.
13400 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
13401 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
13402 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
13403 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
13404 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
13405 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
13406 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
13407 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
13408 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
13409 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
13411 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13412 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
13413 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
13414 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
13420 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
13424 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
13428 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
13429 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
13430 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
13431 predicate are considered.
13435 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13439 An example directory mail source:
13442 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
13447 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13453 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
13454 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13457 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
13458 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
13459 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
13460 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
13461 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
13464 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
13468 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
13469 the user is prompted.
13472 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
13473 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
13476 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
13479 The valid format specifier characters are:
13483 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
13484 included in this string.
13487 The name of the server.
13490 The port number of the server.
13493 The user name to use.
13496 The password to use.
13499 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13500 corresponding keywords.
13503 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13504 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13507 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13508 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13511 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
13512 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
13513 mail should be moved to.
13515 @item :authentication
13516 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
13517 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
13522 @vindex pop3-movemail
13523 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
13524 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
13525 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If the
13526 @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server} is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be
13527 left on the @acronym{POP} server after fetching when using
13528 @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers maintain no state
13529 information between sessions, so what the client believes is there and
13530 what is actually there may not match up. If they do not, then the whole
13531 thing can fall apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
13533 Here are some examples. Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server,
13534 using the default user name, and default fetcher:
13540 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
13543 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
13544 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
13547 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
13550 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
13554 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
13555 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
13556 contains exactly one mail.
13562 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
13563 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
13566 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
13567 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
13569 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
13570 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
13571 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
13574 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
13575 from locking problems).
13579 Two example maildir mail sources:
13582 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
13583 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
13587 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
13592 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
13593 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
13594 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
13595 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
13596 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
13598 Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
13599 may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
13605 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
13606 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13609 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
13610 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
13613 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
13617 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
13621 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
13622 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
13623 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
13624 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
13626 @item :authentication
13627 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
13628 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
13629 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
13630 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
13633 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
13634 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
13635 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
13641 The valid format specifier characters are:
13645 The name of the server.
13648 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
13651 The port number of the server.
13654 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13655 corresponding keywords.
13658 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
13659 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
13662 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
13663 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
13664 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
13665 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
13666 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
13667 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
13670 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
13671 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
13672 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
13673 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
13676 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
13677 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
13681 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
13684 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
13686 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
13690 Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
13691 @uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
13692 @uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
13694 NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
13695 required for url "4.0pre.46".
13697 WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
13703 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
13704 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
13707 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
13711 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
13715 If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
13716 trash folder after finishing the fetch.
13720 An example webmail source:
13723 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
13725 :password "secret")
13730 @item Common Keywords
13731 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
13737 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
13738 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
13743 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
13748 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
13749 useful when you use local mail and news.
13754 @subsubsection Function Interface
13756 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
13757 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
13758 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
13759 consider the following mail-source setting:
13762 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
13763 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
13766 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
13767 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
13768 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
13769 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
13770 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
13772 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
13775 @node Mail Source Customization
13776 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
13778 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
13779 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
13783 @item mail-source-crash-box
13784 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
13785 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
13786 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
13788 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
13789 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
13790 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
13791 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
13792 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
13793 (This will only happen, when receiving new mail). You may also set
13794 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
13795 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
13797 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13798 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13799 If non-@code{nil}, ask for for confirmation before deleting old incoming
13800 files. This variable only applies when
13801 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
13803 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
13804 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
13805 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
13807 @item mail-source-directory
13808 @vindex mail-source-directory
13809 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
13810 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
13811 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
13812 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
13814 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13815 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13816 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
13817 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
13818 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
13819 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
13822 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
13823 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
13824 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
13826 @item mail-source-movemail-program
13827 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
13828 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
13829 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
13834 @node Fetching Mail
13835 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
13837 @vindex mail-sources
13838 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
13839 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
13840 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
13841 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
13843 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
13844 @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to fetch mail by
13847 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
13848 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
13853 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13854 :password "secret")))
13857 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
13861 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
13862 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13865 :password "secret")))
13869 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
13870 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
13871 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
13872 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
13873 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
13874 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
13878 @node Mail Back End Variables
13879 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
13881 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
13885 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13886 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13887 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
13888 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
13890 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
13891 @item nnmail-split-hook
13892 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
13893 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
13894 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
13895 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
13896 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
13897 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
13898 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
13899 in the buffer will show up in any files.
13900 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
13903 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13904 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13905 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13906 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13907 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
13908 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
13909 starting to handle the new mail) and
13910 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
13911 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
13912 default file modes the new mail files get:
13915 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13916 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
13918 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13919 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
13922 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
13923 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
13924 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
13925 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
13926 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
13927 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
13928 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
13930 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
13931 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
13932 @findex delete-file
13933 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
13935 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13936 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13937 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
13938 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
13939 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
13941 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13942 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13943 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
13944 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
13945 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
13947 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
13948 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
13949 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
13954 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
13955 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
13956 @cindex mail splitting
13957 @cindex fancy mail splitting
13959 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
13960 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
13961 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
13962 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
13963 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
13964 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
13966 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
13969 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
13970 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
13971 ;; @r{from real errors.}
13972 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
13974 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
13975 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
13976 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
13977 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
13978 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
13979 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
13980 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
13981 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
13982 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
13983 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
13984 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
13985 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
13986 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
13987 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
13988 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
13989 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
13990 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
13994 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
13995 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
13996 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
14001 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
14002 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
14004 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split})
14005 If the split is a list, the first element of which is a string, then
14006 store the message as specified by @var{split}, if header @var{field}
14007 (a regexp) contains @var{value} (also a regexp). If @var{restrict}
14008 (yet another regexp) matches some string after @var{field} and before
14009 the end of the matched @var{value}, the @var{split} is ignored. If
14010 none of the @var{restrict} clauses match, @var{split} is processed.
14012 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
14013 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
14014 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
14015 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
14016 stored in one or more groups.
14018 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
14019 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
14020 process all @var{split}s in the list.
14023 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
14024 this message. Use with extreme caution.
14026 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
14027 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
14028 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
14029 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
14032 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
14033 body of the messages:
14036 (defun split-on-body ()
14040 (goto-char (point-min))
14041 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
14045 The buffer is narrowed to the message in question when @var{function}
14046 is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called after
14047 @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
14048 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
14049 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
14050 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
14051 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
14053 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
14054 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
14055 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
14056 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
14057 should return a split.
14060 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
14064 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
14065 @var{value} must match a complete word according to the fundamental mode
14066 syntax table. You can use @code{.*} in the regexps to match partial
14067 field names or words. In other words, all @var{value}'s are wrapped in
14068 @samp{\<} and @samp{\>} pairs.
14070 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
14071 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
14072 they are expanded as specified by the variable
14073 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
14074 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
14075 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
14076 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
14080 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
14082 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
14083 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
14085 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
14088 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
14089 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
14090 when all this splitting is performed.
14092 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
14093 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
14094 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
14097 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
14100 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
14101 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
14103 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
14104 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
14105 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
14106 groupings 1 through 9.
14108 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
14109 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
14110 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
14111 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
14112 groups when users send to an address using different case
14113 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
14116 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
14117 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} controls whether partial
14118 words are matched during fancy splitting.
14120 Normally, regular expressions given in @code{nnmail-split-fancy} are
14121 implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers, which are word
14122 delimiters. If this variable is true, they are not implicitly
14123 surrounded by anything.
14126 (any "joe" "joemail")
14129 In this example, messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will
14130 normally not be filed in @samp{joemail}. With
14131 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} set to @code{t},
14132 however, the match will happen. In effect, the requirement of a word
14133 boundary is removed and instead the match becomes more like a grep.
14135 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
14136 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
14137 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
14138 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
14139 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
14140 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
14141 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
14142 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
14143 it once per thread.
14145 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
14146 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
14147 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
14148 using the colon feature, like so:
14150 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
14151 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
14153 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
14154 ;; @r{other splits go here}
14158 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
14159 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
14160 in the file specified by the variable
14161 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
14162 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
14163 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
14164 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
14165 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
14166 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
14167 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
14168 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
14169 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
14170 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
14171 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
14172 300 kBytes in size.)
14173 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14174 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
14175 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
14176 messages goes into the new group.
14178 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
14179 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
14180 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
14181 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
14182 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
14183 ``outgoing'' group.
14186 @node Group Mail Splitting
14187 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
14188 @cindex mail splitting
14189 @cindex group mail splitting
14191 @findex gnus-group-split
14192 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
14193 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
14194 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
14195 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
14196 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
14197 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
14198 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
14199 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
14201 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
14202 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
14203 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
14204 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
14206 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
14207 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
14208 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
14209 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
14210 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
14211 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
14212 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
14214 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
14215 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
14216 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
14217 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
14218 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
14219 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
14220 @code{gnus-group-split}.
14222 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
14223 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
14224 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
14225 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
14226 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
14227 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
14228 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
14229 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
14230 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
14231 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
14232 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
14233 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
14234 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
14236 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
14241 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
14242 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
14244 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
14245 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
14246 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
14247 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
14249 ((split-spec . catch-all))
14252 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
14253 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
14254 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
14257 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
14258 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
14259 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
14263 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
14264 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
14265 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
14269 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
14272 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
14273 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
14274 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
14275 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
14276 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
14277 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
14278 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
14279 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
14280 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
14282 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
14283 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
14284 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
14285 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
14286 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
14287 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
14288 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
14289 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
14290 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
14292 @findex gnus-group-split-update
14293 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
14294 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
14295 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
14296 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
14297 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
14300 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
14303 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
14304 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
14305 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
14306 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
14307 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
14310 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
14311 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
14312 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
14313 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
14315 @node Incorporating Old Mail
14316 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
14317 @cindex incorporating old mail
14318 @cindex import old mail
14320 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
14321 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
14322 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
14325 Doing so can be quite easy.
14327 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
14328 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
14329 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
14330 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
14331 your @code{nnml} groups.
14337 Go to the group buffer.
14340 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
14341 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14344 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
14347 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
14348 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
14351 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
14352 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
14355 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
14356 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
14357 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
14358 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
14359 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
14361 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
14362 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
14363 using the new mail back end.
14366 @node Expiring Mail
14367 @subsection Expiring Mail
14368 @cindex article expiry
14370 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
14371 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
14372 different approach to mail reading.
14374 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
14375 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
14376 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
14377 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
14378 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
14379 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
14382 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
14383 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
14384 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
14385 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
14386 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
14387 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
14388 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
14389 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
14390 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
14392 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
14393 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
14394 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
14395 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
14396 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
14397 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
14398 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
14401 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
14402 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
14403 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
14404 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
14405 into its own group.)
14407 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
14408 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
14409 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
14410 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
14411 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
14412 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
14413 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
14414 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
14417 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14418 Groups that match the regular expression
14419 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
14420 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
14421 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
14423 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
14424 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
14425 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
14426 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
14427 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14429 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
14431 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
14432 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
14433 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
14436 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
14437 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
14438 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
14439 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
14440 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
14442 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
14443 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
14446 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14447 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
14450 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
14451 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
14453 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
14454 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
14455 don't really mix very well.
14457 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
14458 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
14459 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
14460 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
14463 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
14464 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
14465 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
14466 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
14469 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14471 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14473 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
14475 ((string= group "mail.junk")
14477 ((string= group "important")
14483 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
14484 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
14486 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
14487 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
14488 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
14491 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
14492 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
14494 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
14495 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
14496 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
14497 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
14498 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
14499 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
14500 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
14501 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
14502 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
14503 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
14504 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
14505 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
14506 name or @code{delete}.
14508 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
14510 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
14513 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14514 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14515 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
14516 expire mail to groups according to the variable
14517 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
14520 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14521 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14522 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
14523 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
14524 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
14527 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
14528 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
14529 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
14530 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
14531 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
14532 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
14534 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
14535 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
14536 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
14537 easier for procmail users.
14539 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
14540 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
14541 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
14542 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
14543 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
14544 caution. Even more dangerous is the
14545 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
14546 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
14547 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
14548 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
14549 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
14550 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
14551 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
14554 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
14556 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
14557 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
14558 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
14559 auto-expire turned on.
14563 @subsection Washing Mail
14564 @cindex mail washing
14565 @cindex list server brain damage
14566 @cindex incoming mail treatment
14568 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
14569 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
14570 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
14571 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
14572 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
14573 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
14575 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
14576 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
14577 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
14580 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
14581 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
14582 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
14583 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
14586 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14587 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14588 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
14589 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
14590 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
14593 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14594 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14595 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
14596 Emacs running on MS machines.
14600 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14601 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14602 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
14603 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
14606 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14607 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14608 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
14609 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
14611 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
14612 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
14613 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
14614 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
14615 into a feature by documenting it.)
14617 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14618 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14619 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
14620 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
14621 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
14622 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
14623 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
14626 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
14627 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
14630 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
14631 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
14634 This can also be done non-destructively with
14635 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
14637 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
14638 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
14639 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
14641 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14642 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14644 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
14645 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
14646 @code{References} headers.
14650 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14651 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14652 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
14656 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
14657 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
14658 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
14665 @subsection Duplicates
14667 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
14668 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
14669 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
14670 @cindex duplicate mails
14671 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
14672 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
14673 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
14674 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
14675 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
14676 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
14677 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
14678 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
14679 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
14680 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
14681 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
14682 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
14683 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
14685 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
14686 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
14687 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
14688 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
14690 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
14693 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
14694 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
14698 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
14699 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
14700 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
14701 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
14702 (any mail "mail.misc")
14703 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14709 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14710 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
14711 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14715 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
14716 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
14717 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
14718 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
14719 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
14722 @node Not Reading Mail
14723 @subsection Not Reading Mail
14725 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
14726 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
14727 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
14729 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
14730 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
14731 mail, which should help.
14733 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14734 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14735 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14736 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14737 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
14738 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
14739 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
14740 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
14741 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
14742 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
14743 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
14745 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
14746 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
14750 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
14751 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
14753 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
14754 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
14755 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
14757 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
14758 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
14759 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
14763 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
14764 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
14765 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
14766 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
14767 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
14768 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
14769 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
14773 @node Unix Mail Box
14774 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
14776 @cindex unix mail box
14778 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14779 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14780 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
14781 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
14782 which group it belongs in.
14784 Virtual server settings:
14787 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
14788 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14789 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
14792 @item nnmbox-active-file
14793 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14794 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
14795 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
14797 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
14798 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14799 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
14800 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
14805 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
14809 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14810 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14811 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
14812 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
14813 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
14815 Virtual server settings:
14818 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
14819 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14820 The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
14822 @item nnbabyl-active-file
14823 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14824 The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
14825 @file{~/.rmail-active}
14827 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14828 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14829 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
14835 @subsubsection Mail Spool
14837 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
14839 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
14840 format. It should be used with some caution.
14842 @vindex nnml-directory
14843 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
14844 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
14845 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
14846 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
14848 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
14851 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
14852 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
14853 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
14854 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
14855 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
14856 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
14857 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
14858 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
14860 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
14861 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
14862 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
14863 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
14865 @cindex self contained nnml servers
14867 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
14868 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
14869 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
14870 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
14871 for a group is usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
14872 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
14873 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
14874 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
14877 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
14878 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
14879 them next time it starts.
14881 Virtual server settings:
14884 @item nnml-directory
14885 @vindex nnml-directory
14886 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
14887 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
14890 @item nnml-active-file
14891 @vindex nnml-active-file
14892 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
14893 @file{~/Mail/active}.
14895 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
14896 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
14897 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
14898 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
14900 @item nnml-get-new-mail
14901 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14902 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
14905 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
14906 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
14907 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
14908 default is @code{nil}.
14910 @item nnml-nov-file-name
14911 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
14912 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
14914 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
14915 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
14916 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
14918 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
14919 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
14920 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
14921 default is @code{nil}.
14923 @item nnml-marks-file-name
14924 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
14925 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
14927 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
14928 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
14929 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
14934 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
14935 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
14936 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
14937 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
14938 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
14939 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
14940 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
14945 @subsubsection MH Spool
14947 @cindex mh-e mail spool
14949 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
14950 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
14951 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
14952 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
14955 Virtual server settings:
14958 @item nnmh-directory
14959 @vindex nnmh-directory
14960 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
14961 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
14964 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
14965 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14966 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
14970 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
14971 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
14972 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
14973 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
14974 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
14975 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
14976 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
14981 @subsubsection Maildir
14985 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
14986 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
14987 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
14988 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
14989 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
14992 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
14993 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
14994 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
14995 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
14996 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
14997 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
14998 that appear as group in Gnus.
15000 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
15001 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
15002 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
15004 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
15005 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
15006 another, and you will keep your marks.
15008 Virtual server settings:
15012 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
15013 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
15014 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
15015 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
15016 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
15017 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
15018 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
15019 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
15020 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
15021 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
15023 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
15024 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
15025 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
15026 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
15027 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
15028 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
15029 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
15030 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
15031 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
15032 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
15035 @item target-prefix
15036 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
15037 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
15038 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
15041 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
15042 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
15043 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
15044 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
15045 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
15046 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
15047 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
15048 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
15049 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
15051 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
15052 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
15053 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
15054 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
15055 symlinks pointing to them will be).
15057 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
15058 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
15059 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
15060 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
15061 @code{force} argument.
15063 @item directory-files
15064 This should be a function with the same interface as
15065 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
15066 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
15067 parameter is optional; the default is
15068 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
15069 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
15070 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
15071 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
15072 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
15073 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
15076 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
15077 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
15078 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
15079 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
15080 value is @code{nil}.
15082 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
15083 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
15084 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
15085 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
15086 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
15089 @subsubsection Group parameters
15091 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
15092 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
15093 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
15094 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
15095 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
15096 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
15099 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
15100 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
15101 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
15102 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
15103 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
15104 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
15105 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
15106 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
15107 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
15111 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
15112 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
15113 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
15114 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
15115 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
15116 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
15117 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
15118 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
15119 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
15120 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
15121 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
15122 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
15123 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
15126 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
15128 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
15130 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
15131 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
15132 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
15133 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
15134 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
15135 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
15136 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
15137 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
15138 article. So that form can refer to
15139 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
15140 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
15141 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
15142 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
15145 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
15146 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
15147 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
15148 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
15149 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
15150 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
15151 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
15152 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
15153 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
15154 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
15155 contain extra copies of the articles.
15157 @item directory-files
15158 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
15159 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
15160 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
15161 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
15163 @item distrust-Lines:
15164 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
15165 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
15166 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
15169 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
15170 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15171 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
15172 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
15173 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
15174 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15177 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
15178 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15179 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
15180 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
15181 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
15182 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
15183 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15185 @item nov-cache-size
15186 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
15187 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
15188 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
15189 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
15190 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
15191 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
15192 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
15193 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
15194 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
15195 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
15196 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
15199 @subsubsection Article identification
15200 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
15201 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
15202 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
15203 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
15204 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
15205 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
15206 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
15207 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
15208 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
15209 request the article in the summary buffer.
15211 @subsubsection NOV data
15212 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
15213 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
15214 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
15215 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
15216 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
15217 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
15218 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
15219 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
15220 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
15221 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
15222 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
15224 @subsubsection Article marks
15225 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
15226 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
15227 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15228 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
15229 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15230 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
15231 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
15232 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
15234 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
15235 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
15236 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
15237 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
15238 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
15239 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
15240 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
15241 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
15242 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
15246 @subsubsection Mail Folders
15248 @cindex mbox folders
15249 @cindex mail folders
15251 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
15252 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
15253 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
15254 numbers and arrival dates.
15256 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
15258 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
15259 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15260 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15261 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
15262 Marks for a group is usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
15263 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
15264 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
15265 directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
15266 backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
15267 into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
15269 Virtual server settings:
15272 @item nnfolder-directory
15273 @vindex nnfolder-directory
15274 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
15275 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
15276 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
15278 @item nnfolder-active-file
15279 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
15280 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
15282 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15283 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15284 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15285 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
15287 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
15288 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15289 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
15290 default is @code{t}
15292 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15293 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15294 @cindex backup files
15295 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
15296 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
15297 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
15298 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
15301 (defun turn-off-backup ()
15302 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
15304 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
15307 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15308 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15309 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
15310 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
15311 extract some information from it before removing it.
15313 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15314 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15315 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15316 default is @code{nil}.
15318 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15319 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15320 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
15322 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
15323 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
15324 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
15325 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15327 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15328 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15329 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15330 default is @code{nil}.
15332 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15333 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15334 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
15336 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
15337 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
15338 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
15339 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15344 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
15345 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
15346 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
15347 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
15348 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
15349 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
15352 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
15353 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
15355 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
15356 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
15357 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
15358 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
15359 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
15361 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
15362 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
15363 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
15364 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
15365 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
15366 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
15367 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
15368 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
15371 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
15372 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
15373 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
15374 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
15379 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
15380 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
15381 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
15382 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
15383 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
15384 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
15385 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
15386 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
15387 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
15388 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
15389 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
15390 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
15391 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
15396 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
15397 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
15398 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
15399 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
15400 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
15401 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
15402 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
15403 Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
15404 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
15405 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
15406 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
15407 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
15408 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
15409 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
15411 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
15412 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
15417 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
15418 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
15419 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
15420 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
15421 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
15422 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
15423 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
15424 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
15425 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
15426 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
15427 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
15428 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
15429 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
15430 provided by the active file and overviews.
15432 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
15433 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
15434 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
15435 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
15436 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
15439 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
15440 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
15445 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
15446 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
15447 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
15448 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
15449 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
15450 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
15451 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
15455 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
15456 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
15457 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
15458 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
15459 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
15460 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
15461 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
15462 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
15463 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
15465 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
15466 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
15467 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
15468 friendly mail back end all over.
15472 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
15473 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
15476 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
15477 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
15478 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
15479 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
15480 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
15481 @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
15482 you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
15483 @uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
15486 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
15487 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
15488 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
15489 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
15490 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
15491 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
15492 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
15493 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
15494 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
15495 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
15496 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
15498 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
15499 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
15500 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
15501 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
15502 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
15505 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
15506 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
15507 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
15508 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
15509 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
15510 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
15511 removed in the future.
15513 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
15514 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
15515 on your file system.
15517 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
15518 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
15523 @node Browsing the Web
15524 @section Browsing the Web
15526 @cindex browsing the web
15530 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
15531 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
15532 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
15533 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
15534 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
15535 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
15536 even know what a news group is.
15538 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
15539 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
15540 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
15541 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
15542 you mad in the end.
15544 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
15547 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
15548 interfaces to these sources.
15552 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
15553 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
15554 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
15555 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
15556 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
15557 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
15560 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
15561 alternatives to work.
15563 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
15564 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
15565 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
15566 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
15567 though, you should be ok.
15569 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
15570 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
15571 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
15572 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
15573 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
15575 @node Archiving Mail
15576 @subsection Archiving Mail
15577 @cindex archiving mail
15578 @cindex backup of mail
15580 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
15581 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
15582 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
15583 marks is fairly simple.
15585 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
15586 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
15589 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
15590 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
15591 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
15592 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
15593 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
15594 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
15595 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
15596 before you restore the data.
15598 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
15599 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
15600 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
15601 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
15602 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
15603 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
15604 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
15605 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
15606 is unnecessary in that case.
15609 @subsection Web Searches
15614 @cindex Usenet searches
15615 @cindex searching the Usenet
15617 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
15618 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
15619 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
15620 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
15621 searches without having to use a browser.
15623 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
15624 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
15625 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
15626 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
15627 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
15629 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
15630 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
15631 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
15632 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
15633 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
15634 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
15635 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
15636 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
15637 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
15638 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
15641 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
15642 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
15643 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
15644 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
15645 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
15646 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
15648 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
15649 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
15650 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
15652 Virtual server variables:
15657 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
15658 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
15659 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
15662 @vindex nnweb-search
15663 The search string to feed to the search engine.
15665 @item nnweb-max-hits
15666 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
15667 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
15670 @item nnweb-type-definition
15671 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
15672 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
15673 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
15678 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
15682 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
15685 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
15688 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
15692 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
15699 @subsection Slashdot
15703 @uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
15704 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
15705 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
15707 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
15708 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15711 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
15712 '((nnslashdot "")))
15715 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
15716 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
15717 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
15718 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
15719 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
15722 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
15723 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15725 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
15726 comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
15727 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
15728 @samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
15729 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
15730 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
15731 @acronym{HTML} forms.
15733 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
15736 @item nnslashdot-threaded
15737 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
15738 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
15739 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
15740 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
15741 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
15742 but much, much slower than unthreaded.
15744 @item nnslashdot-login-name
15745 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
15746 The login name to use when posting.
15748 @item nnslashdot-password
15749 @vindex nnslashdot-password
15750 The password to use when posting.
15752 @item nnslashdot-directory
15753 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
15754 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
15755 @file{~/News/slashdot/}.
15757 @item nnslashdot-active-url
15758 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
15759 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
15760 information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
15761 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
15763 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
15764 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
15765 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
15767 @item nnslashdot-article-url
15768 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
15769 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
15770 article. The default is
15771 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
15773 @item nnslashdot-threshold
15774 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
15775 The score threshold. The default is -1.
15777 @item nnslashdot-group-number
15778 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
15779 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
15780 updated. The default is 0.
15787 @subsection Ultimate
15789 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
15791 @uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
15792 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
15793 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
15794 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15796 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
15797 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
15798 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
15799 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
15800 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
15801 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
15802 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
15804 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
15807 @item nnultimate-directory
15808 @vindex nnultimate-directory
15809 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
15810 @file{~/News/ultimate/}.
15815 @subsection Web Archive
15817 @cindex Web Archive
15819 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
15820 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
15821 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
15822 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
15825 @findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
15826 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
15827 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
15828 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
15829 www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
15830 @var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
15831 @var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
15832 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
15834 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
15837 @item nnwarchive-directory
15838 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
15839 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
15840 @file{~/News/warchive/}.
15842 @item nnwarchive-login
15843 @vindex nnwarchive-login
15844 The account name on the web server.
15846 @item nnwarchive-passwd
15847 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
15848 The password for your account on the web server.
15856 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
15857 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
15858 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
15859 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
15860 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
15862 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
15863 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15865 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
15866 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
15867 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
15870 @kindex G R (Group)
15871 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
15872 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
15873 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
15874 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
15876 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
15877 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
15878 subscribe to groups.
15880 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
15881 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
15882 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
15883 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
15884 variable. If it is @code{nil}, in Emacs the coding system defaults to
15885 the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system}. If you are using
15886 XEmacs and want to use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names, you should set
15887 the value for the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} variable properly.
15890 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
15891 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
15894 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
15895 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
15899 @defun nnrss-opml-export
15900 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
15901 @acronym{OPML} format.
15904 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
15907 @item nnrss-directory
15908 @vindex nnrss-directory
15909 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
15910 @file{~/News/rss/}.
15912 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
15913 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
15914 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
15915 data files. The default is the value of
15916 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
15917 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
15919 @item nnrss-use-local
15920 @vindex nnrss-use-local
15921 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
15922 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
15923 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
15924 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
15925 download script using @command{wget}.
15928 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
15929 the summary buffer.
15932 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
15933 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
15935 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
15937 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
15938 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
15941 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
15944 (require 'browse-url)
15946 (defun browse-nnrss-url( arg )
15948 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
15951 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
15952 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
15955 (browse-url (cdr url))
15956 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
15957 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
15959 (eval-after-load "gnus"
15960 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
15961 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
15962 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
15965 @node Customizing W3
15966 @subsection Customizing W3
15972 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
15973 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
15974 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
15977 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
15978 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
15979 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
15982 (eval-after-load "w3"
15984 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
15985 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
15986 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
15987 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
15989 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
15992 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
15993 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
16000 @cindex @acronym{IMAP}
16002 @acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
16003 think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
16004 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
16005 specify the network address of the server.
16007 @acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
16008 everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
16009 @acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
16010 similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
16011 @acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
16012 is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
16014 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
16015 entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
16016 the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
16017 not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
16019 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
16020 entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
16021 manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
16022 usage explained in this section.
16024 A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
16025 servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
16026 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
16030 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16031 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
16032 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
16034 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16035 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
16036 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
16038 (nnimap-server-port 143)
16039 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16040 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
16041 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
16042 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
16043 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
16044 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
16045 (nnimap-stream network))
16046 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
16048 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
16049 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
16050 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
16053 After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
16054 server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
16055 (@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
16056 (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
16058 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
16063 @item nnimap-address
16064 @vindex nnimap-address
16066 The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
16067 server name if not specified.
16069 @item nnimap-server-port
16070 @vindex nnimap-server-port
16071 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
16073 Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
16076 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16077 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
16080 @item nnimap-list-pattern
16081 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
16082 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
16083 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
16084 interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
16085 @acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
16086 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
16088 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
16089 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
16090 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
16093 Example server specification:
16096 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16097 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
16098 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
16101 @item nnimap-stream
16102 @vindex nnimap-stream
16103 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
16104 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
16105 of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
16106 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
16107 be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
16109 Example server specification:
16112 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16113 (nnimap-stream ssl))
16116 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
16120 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
16121 @samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
16123 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
16125 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
16126 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
16129 @dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
16130 @samp{gnutls-cli}).
16132 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
16133 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
16135 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
16137 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
16140 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
16141 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
16142 using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
16143 1.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
16144 to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
16145 with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
16146 restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
16147 indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
16148 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
16151 For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
16152 needed. It is available from
16153 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
16155 @vindex imap-gssapi-program
16156 This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
16157 authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
16158 sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
16159 exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
16160 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
16161 program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
16164 @vindex imap-ssl-program
16165 For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
16166 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
16167 and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
16168 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
16169 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
16170 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
16173 @vindex imap-shell-program
16174 @vindex imap-shell-host
16175 For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
16176 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
16178 @item nnimap-authenticator
16179 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
16181 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
16182 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
16184 Example server specification:
16187 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16188 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
16191 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
16195 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
16196 external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
16198 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
16201 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
16202 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
16204 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
16206 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
16208 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
16211 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
16213 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
16214 Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
16215 don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
16216 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
16217 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
16218 nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
16221 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
16222 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
16223 running in circles yet?
16225 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
16226 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
16229 The possible options are:
16234 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
16237 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
16238 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
16239 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
16240 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
16242 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
16247 @item nnimap-importantize-dormant
16248 @vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
16250 If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
16251 well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
16252 naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
16253 articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
16254 clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
16257 Probably the only reason for frobing this would be if you're trying
16258 enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
16261 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
16262 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16263 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
16264 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16267 In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
16268 as ticked for other users.
16270 @item nnimap-expunge-search-string
16272 @vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
16274 This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
16275 searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
16276 @code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
16277 UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
16279 Probably the only useful value to change this to is
16280 @code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
16281 messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
16282 RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
16284 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
16285 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
16287 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
16288 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
16289 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
16290 @ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
16293 machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
16296 Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
16297 use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
16298 actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
16299 convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
16302 @item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16303 @vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16305 Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
16306 seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
16312 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
16313 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
16314 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
16315 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
16316 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
16317 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
16322 @node Splitting in IMAP
16323 @subsection Splitting in IMAP
16324 @cindex splitting imap mail
16326 Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
16327 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
16328 @acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
16329 splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
16330 @acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
16334 (Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
16335 gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
16336 Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
16338 Here are the variables of interest:
16342 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
16343 @cindex splitting, crosspost
16345 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
16347 If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
16348 mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
16349 found will be used.
16351 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
16353 @item nnimap-split-inbox
16354 @cindex splitting, inbox
16356 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
16358 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
16359 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
16360 splitting is disabled!
16363 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
16364 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
16367 No nnmail equivalent.
16369 @item nnimap-split-rule
16370 @cindex splitting, rules
16371 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
16373 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
16376 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
16377 sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
16378 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
16379 Neither did I, we need examples.
16382 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16384 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
16385 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
16386 ("INBOX.private" "")))
16389 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
16390 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
16391 into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
16393 The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
16394 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
16398 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
16401 The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
16402 matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
16404 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
16405 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
16406 containing the headers of the article. It should return a
16407 non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
16409 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
16410 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
16411 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
16412 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
16413 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
16414 them every time you fetch new mail.)
16416 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
16417 end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
16418 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
16420 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
16421 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
16422 thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16424 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
16426 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
16427 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
16428 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
16431 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16432 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
16433 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
16434 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
16435 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
16436 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
16439 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
16440 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
16441 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
16442 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
16443 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
16444 group/function elements.
16446 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
16448 @item nnimap-split-predicate
16450 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
16452 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
16453 split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
16455 This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
16456 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
16457 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
16460 @item nnimap-split-fancy
16461 @cindex splitting, fancy
16462 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
16463 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
16465 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16466 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
16467 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
16469 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
16470 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16471 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
16472 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16477 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
16478 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
16481 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
16483 @item nnimap-split-download-body
16484 @findex nnimap-split-download-body
16485 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
16487 Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
16488 This is generally not required, and will slow things down
16489 considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
16490 splitting function that analyzes the body to split the article.
16494 @node Expiring in IMAP
16495 @subsection Expiring in IMAP
16496 @cindex expiring imap mail
16498 Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
16499 end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
16500 Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
16501 IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
16502 @var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
16503 follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
16506 A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
16507 appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
16508 @code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
16509 message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
16510 the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
16511 you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
16512 your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
16513 messages. Most do, fortunately.
16517 @item nnmail-expiry-wait
16518 @item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16520 These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
16521 number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
16523 @item nnmail-expiry-target
16525 This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
16526 @code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
16527 that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
16528 article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
16532 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
16533 @subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
16534 @cindex editing imap acls
16535 @cindex Access Control Lists
16536 @cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
16537 @kindex G l (Group)
16538 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
16540 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
16541 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
16542 @acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
16545 To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
16546 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
16547 editing window with detailed instructions.
16549 Some possible uses:
16553 Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
16554 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
16555 follow the list without subscribing to it.
16557 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
16558 ``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
16559 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
16563 @node Expunging mailboxes
16564 @subsection Expunging mailboxes
16568 @cindex manual expunging
16569 @kindex G x (Group)
16570 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
16572 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
16573 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
16574 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
16576 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
16579 @node A note on namespaces
16580 @subsection A note on namespaces
16581 @cindex IMAP namespace
16584 The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
16585 by the following text in the RFC2060:
16588 5.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
16590 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
16591 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
16592 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
16593 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
16595 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
16596 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
16597 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
16598 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
16599 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
16600 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
16603 While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
16604 @acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
16605 prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
16607 Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
16608 mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
16609 in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
16610 created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
16611 without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
16612 not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
16613 mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
16614 you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
16617 See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
16618 for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
16619 tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
16621 @node Debugging IMAP
16622 @subsection Debugging IMAP
16623 @cindex IMAP debugging
16624 @cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
16626 @acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
16627 @acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
16628 best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behavior, chances
16629 are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
16631 If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
16632 probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
16633 exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
16634 with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
16635 @acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
16636 critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
16637 to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
16641 Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
16642 disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
16649 This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
16650 the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
16651 for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
16652 @code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
16655 @node Other Sources
16656 @section Other Sources
16658 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
16659 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
16663 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
16664 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
16665 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
16666 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
16667 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
16671 @node Directory Groups
16672 @subsection Directory Groups
16674 @cindex directory groups
16676 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
16677 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
16680 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
16681 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
16682 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
16683 back end to read directories. Big deal.
16685 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
16686 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
16687 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
16688 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
16689 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
16691 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
16693 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
16694 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
16695 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
16696 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
16699 @node Anything Groups
16700 @subsection Anything Groups
16703 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
16704 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
16705 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
16708 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
16709 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
16710 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
16711 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
16712 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
16713 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
16714 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
16715 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
16716 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
16717 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
16720 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
16721 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
16722 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
16723 in the article buffer, just as usual.
16725 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
16726 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
16727 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
16728 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
16730 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
16731 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
16732 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
16733 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
16734 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
16735 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
16736 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
16737 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
16742 @item nneething-map-file-directory
16743 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
16744 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
16745 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
16747 @item nneething-exclude-files
16748 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
16749 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
16750 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
16752 @item nneething-include-files
16753 @vindex nneething-include-files
16754 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
16755 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
16757 @item nneething-map-file
16758 @vindex nneething-map-file
16759 Name of the map files.
16763 @node Document Groups
16764 @subsection Document Groups
16766 @cindex documentation group
16769 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
16770 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
16776 The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
16781 The standard Unix mbox file.
16783 @cindex MMDF mail box
16785 The MMDF mail box format.
16788 Several news articles appended into a file.
16790 @cindex rnews batch files
16792 The rnews batch transport format.
16795 Netscape mail boxes.
16798 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
16800 @item standard-digest
16801 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
16804 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
16806 @item lanl-gov-announce
16807 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
16809 @cindex forwarded messages
16810 @item rfc822-forward
16811 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
16814 The Outlook mail box.
16817 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
16820 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
16823 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
16826 An RFC934-forwarded message.
16832 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
16835 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
16841 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
16842 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
16843 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
16846 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
16847 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
16848 group. And that's it.
16850 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
16851 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
16852 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
16853 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
16854 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
16855 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
16856 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
16857 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
16858 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
16859 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
16861 Virtual server variables:
16864 @item nndoc-article-type
16865 @vindex nndoc-article-type
16866 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
16867 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
16868 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
16869 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
16870 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
16872 @item nndoc-post-type
16873 @vindex nndoc-post-type
16874 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
16875 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
16880 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
16884 @node Document Server Internals
16885 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
16887 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
16888 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
16889 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
16890 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
16892 First, here's an example document type definition:
16896 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
16897 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
16900 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
16901 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
16902 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
16903 types can be defined with very few settings:
16906 @item first-article
16907 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
16908 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
16911 @item article-begin
16912 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
16913 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
16914 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
16915 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
16917 @item article-begin-function
16918 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
16919 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
16922 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
16923 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
16924 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
16926 @item head-begin-function
16927 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
16928 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
16931 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
16932 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
16935 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
16936 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
16937 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
16939 @item body-begin-function
16940 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
16941 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
16944 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
16945 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
16946 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
16948 @item body-end-function
16949 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
16950 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
16953 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
16954 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
16957 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
16958 regexp will be totally ignored.
16962 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
16963 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
16964 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
16965 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
16966 something that's palatable for Gnus:
16969 @item prepare-body-function
16970 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
16971 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
16972 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
16974 @item article-transform-function
16975 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
16976 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
16977 body of the article.
16979 @item generate-head-function
16980 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
16981 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
16982 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
16983 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
16985 @item generate-article-function
16986 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
16987 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
16988 parameter when requesting all articles.
16990 @item dissection-function
16991 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
16992 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
16993 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
16994 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
16995 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
16996 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17000 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17005 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17006 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17007 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17008 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17009 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17010 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17011 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17012 (subtype digest guess))
17015 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17016 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17017 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17018 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17019 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17021 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17022 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17023 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17024 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17025 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17026 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17027 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17028 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17029 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17030 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17031 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17032 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17040 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
17041 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
17042 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
17044 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
17045 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
17046 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
17049 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
17050 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
17051 that interested in doing things properly.
17053 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
17054 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
17057 First some terminology:
17062 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
17063 get news and/or mail from.
17066 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
17067 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
17070 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
17074 @item message packets
17075 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
17076 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
17077 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17079 @item response packets
17080 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
17081 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
17082 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17092 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
17093 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
17094 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
17095 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
17098 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
17101 You put the packet in your home directory.
17104 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
17105 the native or secondary server.
17108 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
17109 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
17112 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
17116 You transfer this packet to the server.
17119 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
17122 You then repeat until you die.
17126 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
17127 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
17130 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
17131 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
17132 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
17136 @node SOUP Commands
17137 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
17139 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
17143 @kindex G s b (Group)
17144 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
17145 Pack all unread articles in the current group
17146 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
17147 process/prefix convention.
17150 @kindex G s w (Group)
17151 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
17152 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
17155 @kindex G s s (Group)
17156 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
17157 Send all replies from the replies packet
17158 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
17161 @kindex G s p (Group)
17162 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
17163 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
17166 @kindex G s r (Group)
17167 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
17168 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
17171 @kindex O s (Summary)
17172 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
17173 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
17174 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
17175 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
17180 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
17185 @item gnus-soup-directory
17186 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
17187 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
17188 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
17190 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
17191 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
17192 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
17193 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
17195 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
17196 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
17197 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
17198 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
17200 @item gnus-soup-packer
17201 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
17202 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17203 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
17205 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
17206 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
17207 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17208 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17210 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
17211 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
17212 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
17214 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17215 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17216 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
17217 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
17223 @subsubsection SOUP Groups
17226 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
17227 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
17228 you can read them at leisure.
17230 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
17234 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
17235 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
17236 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
17237 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
17239 @item nnsoup-directory
17240 @vindex nnsoup-directory
17241 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
17242 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
17244 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
17245 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
17246 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
17247 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
17249 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
17250 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
17251 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
17252 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
17253 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
17255 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
17256 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
17257 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
17258 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
17260 @item nnsoup-active-file
17261 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
17262 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
17263 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
17264 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
17265 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
17267 @item nnsoup-packer
17268 @vindex nnsoup-packer
17269 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
17270 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
17272 @item nnsoup-unpacker
17273 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
17274 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
17275 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17277 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
17278 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
17279 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
17282 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
17283 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
17284 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
17287 @item nnsoup-always-save
17288 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
17289 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
17295 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
17297 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
17298 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
17299 more for that to happen.
17301 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
17302 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
17303 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
17306 In specific, this is what it does:
17309 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
17310 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
17313 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
17314 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
17315 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
17318 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17319 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17320 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17323 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17324 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17325 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17327 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17333 @item nngateway-address
17334 @vindex nngateway-address
17335 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17337 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17338 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17339 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17340 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17341 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17342 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17343 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17346 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17347 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17348 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17351 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17354 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17357 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17360 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17362 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17365 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17366 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17367 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17369 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17371 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17372 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17373 @code{nngateway-address}.
17381 (setq gnus-post-method
17383 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17384 (nngateway-header-transformation
17385 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17388 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17391 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17396 @node Combined Groups
17397 @section Combined Groups
17399 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17403 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17404 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
17408 @node Virtual Groups
17409 @subsection Virtual Groups
17411 @cindex virtual groups
17412 @cindex merging groups
17414 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17417 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17418 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17419 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17421 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17422 regexp to match component groups.
17424 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17425 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17426 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17427 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17428 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17429 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17430 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17431 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17433 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17434 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17437 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17440 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17441 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17443 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17444 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17445 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17446 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17449 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17452 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17453 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17454 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17456 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17457 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17458 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17459 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17460 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17462 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17463 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17464 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17466 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17467 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} is non-@code{nil},
17468 @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread articles when
17469 entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
17470 default) and you read articles in a component group after the virtual
17471 group has been activated, the read articles from the component group
17472 will show up when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this
17473 effect if you have two virtual groups that have a component group in
17474 common. If that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}.
17475 Or you can just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before
17476 you enter it---it'll have much the same effect.
17478 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17479 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17480 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17481 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17482 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17483 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17484 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17486 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17487 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17489 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17490 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17494 @node Kibozed Groups
17495 @subsection Kibozed Groups
17499 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
17500 (parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
17501 do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
17502 down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
17504 @kindex G k (Group)
17505 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
17508 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
17509 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
17510 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
17511 @code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
17513 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
17514 @code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
17515 to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
17517 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
17518 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
17519 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
17520 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
17521 Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
17522 headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
17523 through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
17524 the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
17526 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
17527 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
17528 @acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
17529 Stranger things have happened.
17531 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
17532 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
17534 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
17535 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
17536 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
17537 One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
17538 the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
17539 information on what groups have been searched through to find
17540 component articles.
17542 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
17543 their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
17546 @node Gnus Unplugged
17547 @section Gnus Unplugged
17552 @cindex Gnus unplugged
17554 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
17555 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
17556 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
17557 read news. Believe it or not.
17559 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
17560 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
17561 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
17562 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
17563 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
17565 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
17566 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
17567 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
17568 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
17569 reading news on a machine.
17571 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
17572 fact, you don't even have to configure anything.
17574 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
17577 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
17578 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
17579 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
17580 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
17581 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
17582 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
17583 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
17584 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
17585 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
17586 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
17587 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
17588 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
17589 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
17594 @subsection Agent Basics
17596 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
17598 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
17599 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
17600 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
17601 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
17603 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
17604 connected to the net continuously.
17606 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
17607 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
17609 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
17610 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
17611 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
17612 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
17613 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
17615 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
17616 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
17617 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
17618 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
17619 they're kinda like plugged always).
17621 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
17622 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
17623 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
17626 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
17627 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
17628 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
17629 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
17630 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
17632 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
17637 @findex gnus-unplugged
17638 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
17639 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
17640 already fetched while in this mode.
17643 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
17644 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
17645 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
17646 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
17647 Source Specifiers}).
17650 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
17651 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
17652 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
17653 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
17654 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
17657 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
17658 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
17659 then you read the news offline.
17662 And then you go to step 2.
17665 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
17671 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
17672 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
17673 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
17674 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
17675 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
17676 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
17677 all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
17678 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
17681 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
17682 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
17683 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
17684 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
17686 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
17687 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
17688 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
17689 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
17690 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
17691 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
17695 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
17699 @node Agent Categories
17700 @subsection Agent Categories
17702 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
17703 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
17704 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
17705 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
17706 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
17707 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
17708 you're interested in the articles anyway.
17710 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
17711 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
17712 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
17713 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
17714 buffer for creating and managing categories.
17716 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
17717 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
17718 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
17719 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
17720 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
17723 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
17724 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
17725 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
17726 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
17727 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
17728 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
17732 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
17733 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
17734 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
17738 @node Category Syntax
17739 @subsubsection Category Syntax
17741 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
17742 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
17743 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
17746 @cindex Agent Parameters
17748 @item gnus-agent-cat-name
17749 The name of the category.
17751 @item gnus-agent-cat-groups
17752 The list of groups that are in this category.
17754 @item gnus-agent-cat-predicate
17755 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
17756 are eligible for downloading; and
17758 @item gnus-agent-cat-score-file
17759 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
17760 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
17761 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
17763 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-expiration
17764 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
17765 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
17766 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
17767 only groups that should not be expired.
17769 @item gnus-agent-cat-days-until-old
17770 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
17771 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
17773 @item gnus-agent-cat-low-score
17774 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
17776 @item gnus-agent-cat-high-score
17777 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
17779 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-short
17780 an integer that overrides the value of
17781 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
17783 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-long
17784 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
17786 @c @item gnus-agent-cat-disable-undownloaded-faces
17787 @c a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should @emph{not} display
17788 @c undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17789 @c faces. The symbol nil will enable the use of undownloaded faces while
17790 @c all other symbols disable them.
17792 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-undownloaded-faces
17793 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
17794 undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17795 faces. The symbol nil will disable the use of undownloaded faces while
17796 all other symbols enable them.
17799 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
17802 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
17803 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
17804 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
17807 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
17808 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
17809 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
17810 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
17812 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
17813 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
17814 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
17816 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
17817 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
17818 operators sprinkled in between.
17820 Perhaps some examples are in order.
17822 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
17823 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
17829 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
17830 short (for some value of ``short'').
17832 Here's a more complex predicate:
17841 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
17842 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
17845 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
17846 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
17847 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
17849 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
17850 you want to do, you can write your own.
17852 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
17853 bound to the value determined by calling
17854 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
17855 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
17856 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
17857 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
17858 predicate to individual groups.
17862 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
17863 lines; default 100.
17866 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
17867 lines; default 200.
17870 True iff the article has a download score less than
17871 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
17874 True iff the article has a download score greater than
17875 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
17878 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
17879 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
17880 checksum and sees whether articles match.
17889 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
17890 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
17891 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
17894 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
17895 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
17896 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
17897 something along the lines of the following:
17900 (defun my-article-old-p ()
17901 "Say whether an article is old."
17902 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
17903 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
17906 with the predicate then defined as:
17909 (not my-article-old-p)
17912 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
17913 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
17917 (require 'gnus-agent)
17918 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
17919 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
17920 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
17923 and simply specify your predicate as:
17929 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
17930 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
17931 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
17932 just don't give a damn.
17934 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
17935 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
17936 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
17937 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
17938 parameters like so:
17941 (agent-predicate . short)
17944 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
17945 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
17946 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
17948 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
17951 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
17954 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
17955 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
17956 predicate is assumed to be a list.
17959 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
17960 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
17961 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
17962 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
17963 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
17964 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
17966 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
17967 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
17968 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
17969 if it's to be specific to that group.
17971 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
17978 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
17979 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
17985 Category specification
17989 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
17995 Group/Topic Parameter specification
17998 (agent-score ("from"
17999 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18004 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18010 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18011 keywords stated above.
18017 Category specification
18020 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18026 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18030 Group Parameter specification
18033 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18036 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18041 Use @code{normal} score files
18043 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18044 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18045 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18046 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18048 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18049 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18050 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18051 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18055 Category Specification
18062 Group Parameter specification
18065 (agent-score . file)
18070 @node Category Buffer
18071 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18073 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18074 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18075 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18077 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18081 @kindex q (Category)
18082 @findex gnus-category-exit
18083 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18086 @kindex e (Category)
18087 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18088 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18089 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18092 @kindex k (Category)
18093 @findex gnus-category-kill
18094 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18097 @kindex c (Category)
18098 @findex gnus-category-copy
18099 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18102 @kindex a (Category)
18103 @findex gnus-category-add
18104 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18107 @kindex p (Category)
18108 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18109 Edit the predicate of the current category
18110 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18113 @kindex g (Category)
18114 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18115 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18116 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18119 @kindex s (Category)
18120 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18121 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18122 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18125 @kindex l (Category)
18126 @findex gnus-category-list
18127 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18131 @node Category Variables
18132 @subsubsection Category Variables
18135 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18136 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18137 Hook run in category buffers.
18139 @item gnus-category-line-format
18140 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18141 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18142 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18146 The name of the category.
18149 The number of groups in the category.
18152 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18153 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18154 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18156 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18157 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18158 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18160 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18161 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18162 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18164 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18165 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18166 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18169 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18170 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18171 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18174 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18175 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18176 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18177 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18178 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18179 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18180 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18181 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18185 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18186 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18187 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18188 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18189 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18190 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18191 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18196 @node Agent Commands
18197 @subsection Agent Commands
18198 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18199 @kindex J j (Agent)
18201 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18202 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18203 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18207 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18208 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18209 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18215 @node Group Agent Commands
18216 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18220 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18221 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18222 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18223 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18226 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18227 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18228 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18231 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18232 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18233 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18234 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18237 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18238 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18239 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18240 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18243 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18244 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18245 Add the current group to an Agent category
18246 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18247 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18250 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18251 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18252 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18253 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18254 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18257 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18258 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18259 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18265 @node Summary Agent Commands
18266 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18270 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18271 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18272 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18275 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18276 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18277 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18278 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18282 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18283 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18284 Toggle whether to download the article
18285 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18289 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18290 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18291 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18294 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18295 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18296 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18297 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18300 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18301 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-series
18302 Download all processable articles in this group.
18303 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-series}).
18306 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18307 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18308 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18309 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18314 @node Server Agent Commands
18315 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18319 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18320 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18321 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18322 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18325 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18326 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18327 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18328 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18333 @node Agent Visuals
18334 @subsection Agent Visuals
18336 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18337 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18338 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18339 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18340 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18341 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18342 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18343 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18344 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18345 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18347 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18348 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18349 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18350 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18351 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18352 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18353 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18354 articles will be available when unplugged.
18356 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18357 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18358 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18359 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18360 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18361 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18362 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18363 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18365 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18366 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18367 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18368 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18369 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18370 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18371 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18372 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18373 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18375 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18376 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18377 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18378 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18379 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear.
18381 For occasional Agent users, the undownloaded faces may appear to be an
18382 absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since most of their
18383 articles have not been fetched into the Agent, most of the normal
18384 faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces. If this is your
18385 situation, you have two choices available. First, you can completely
18386 disable the undownload faces by customizing
18387 @code{gnus-summary-highlight} to delete the three cons-cells that
18388 refer to the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face} faces. Second,
18389 if you prefer to take a more fine-grained approach, you may set the
18390 @code{agent-disable-undownloaded-faces} group parameter to @code{t}.
18391 This parameter, like all other agent parameters, may be set on an
18392 Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}), a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic
18393 Parameters}), or an individual group (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18395 @node Agent as Cache
18396 @subsection Agent as Cache
18398 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18399 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18400 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18401 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18402 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18403 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18404 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18405 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18406 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18408 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18409 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18410 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18411 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18412 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18415 @subsection Agent Expiry
18417 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18418 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18419 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18420 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18421 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18422 @cindex agent expiry
18423 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18426 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18427 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18428 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18429 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18430 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18431 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18432 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18433 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18435 Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
18436 might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
18437 synchronized with the group.
18439 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18440 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18442 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18443 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18444 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18445 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18446 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18447 be kept indefinitely.
18449 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18450 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18451 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18452 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18454 @node Agent Regeneration
18455 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18457 @cindex agent regeneration
18458 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18459 @cindex regeneration
18461 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
18462 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
18463 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
18464 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
18465 internal inconsistencies.
18467 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
18468 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
18469 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
18470 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
18471 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
18472 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
18474 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
18475 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
18476 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
18477 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
18478 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
18479 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
18481 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18482 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18483 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
18484 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
18485 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
18486 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
18489 @node Agent and IMAP
18490 @subsection Agent and IMAP
18492 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
18493 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
18494 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
18495 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
18497 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
18498 are kept on the @acronym{IMAP} server, rather than in @file{.newsrc} as is the
18499 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
18500 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
18502 Gnus keeps track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
18503 Agent. When you plug back in, Gnus will check if you have any changed
18504 any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the server.
18505 The behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
18507 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18508 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
18509 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
18510 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
18511 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
18512 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
18514 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
18515 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
18516 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
18517 in the group buffer.
18519 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
18520 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
18525 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
18528 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
18532 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
18533 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
18534 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
18535 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group and
18536 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
18537 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
18538 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
18539 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
18542 @node Outgoing Messages
18543 @subsection Outgoing Messages
18545 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
18546 stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view
18547 them there after posting, and edit them at will.
18549 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
18550 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
18551 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
18552 messages in the draft group.
18556 @node Agent Variables
18557 @subsection Agent Variables
18560 @item gnus-agent-directory
18561 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
18562 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
18563 @file{~/News/agent/}.
18565 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
18566 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
18567 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
18568 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
18569 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
18572 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18573 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18574 Hook run when connecting to the network.
18576 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18577 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18578 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
18580 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18581 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18582 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
18584 @item gnus-agent-cache
18585 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
18586 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
18587 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
18588 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
18590 @item gnus-agent-go-online
18591 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
18592 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
18593 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
18594 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
18595 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
18596 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
18599 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18600 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18601 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
18602 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
18603 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
18604 read. The default is @code{t}.
18606 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18607 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18608 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
18609 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
18610 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
18611 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
18612 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
18613 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
18614 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
18615 over and over again.
18617 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18618 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18619 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
18620 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
18621 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
18622 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
18623 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
18624 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
18625 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
18626 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
18627 However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
18628 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
18631 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
18632 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
18633 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
18634 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
18635 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
18636 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
18637 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
18638 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
18639 is only valid if the Agent is used.
18641 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18642 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18643 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
18644 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
18645 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
18646 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
18648 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
18649 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
18650 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
18651 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
18652 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
18654 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18655 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18656 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
18657 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
18658 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
18659 which backends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
18660 to agentize remote backends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
18661 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
18662 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
18663 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
18664 start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
18669 @node Example Setup
18670 @subsection Example Setup
18672 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
18673 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
18674 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
18677 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
18678 ;;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
18679 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
18681 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
18682 ;;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
18683 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
18685 ;;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
18686 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
18688 ;;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
18689 ;;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
18690 ;;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
18693 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
18694 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
18697 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
18698 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
18699 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
18700 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
18701 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
18704 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
18705 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
18706 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
18707 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
18708 back all the killed groups.)
18710 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
18711 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
18712 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
18715 @node Batching Agents
18716 @subsection Batching Agents
18717 @findex gnus-agent-batch
18719 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
18720 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
18721 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
18723 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
18724 following incantation:
18728 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
18732 @node Agent Caveats
18733 @subsection Agent Caveats
18735 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
18736 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
18740 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
18742 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
18743 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
18744 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
18746 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
18747 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
18749 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
18753 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
18754 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
18755 locally stored articles.
18762 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
18763 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
18764 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
18767 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
18768 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
18769 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
18770 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
18771 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
18773 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
18774 before generating the summary buffer.
18776 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
18777 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
18778 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
18780 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
18781 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
18782 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
18783 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
18786 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
18787 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
18788 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
18789 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
18790 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
18791 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
18792 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
18793 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
18794 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
18795 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
18796 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
18797 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
18798 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
18799 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
18800 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
18801 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
18802 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
18806 @node Summary Score Commands
18807 @section Summary Score Commands
18808 @cindex score commands
18810 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
18811 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
18812 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
18813 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
18814 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
18816 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
18817 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
18818 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
18819 score file the current one.
18821 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
18826 @kindex V s (Summary)
18827 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
18828 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
18831 @kindex V S (Summary)
18832 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
18833 Display the score of the current article
18834 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
18837 @kindex V t (Summary)
18838 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
18839 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
18840 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
18841 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
18842 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
18843 score file and edit it.
18846 @kindex V w (Summary)
18847 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
18848 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
18851 @kindex V R (Summary)
18852 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
18853 Run the current summary through the scoring process
18854 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
18855 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
18856 effect you're having.
18859 @kindex V c (Summary)
18860 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
18861 Make a different score file the current
18862 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
18865 @kindex V e (Summary)
18866 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
18867 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
18868 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
18872 @kindex V f (Summary)
18873 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
18874 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
18875 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
18878 @kindex V F (Summary)
18879 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
18880 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
18881 after editing score files.
18884 @kindex V C (Summary)
18885 @findex gnus-score-customize
18886 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
18887 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
18891 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
18896 @kindex V m (Summary)
18897 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
18898 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
18899 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
18902 @kindex V x (Summary)
18903 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
18904 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
18905 expunge all articles below this score
18906 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
18909 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
18910 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
18913 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
18914 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
18918 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
18919 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
18921 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
18922 keys are available:
18926 Score on the author name.
18929 Score on the subject line.
18932 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
18935 Score on the @code{References} line.
18941 Score on the number of lines.
18944 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
18947 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
18948 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
18951 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
18952 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
18953 @file{ADAPT} files.)
18962 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
18968 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
18969 what headers you are scoring on.
18981 Substring matching.
18984 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19013 Greater than number.
19018 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19019 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19020 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19025 Temporary score entry.
19028 Permanent score entry.
19031 Immediately scoring.
19035 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19036 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19037 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19041 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19042 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19043 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19044 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19046 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19047 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19048 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19049 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19050 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19052 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19053 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19054 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19055 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19056 current score file.
19058 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19059 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19060 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19063 @node Group Score Commands
19064 @section Group Score Commands
19065 @cindex group score commands
19067 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19072 @kindex W f (Group)
19073 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19074 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19075 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19076 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19080 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19082 @findex gnus-batch-score
19083 @cindex batch scoring
19085 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19089 @node Score Variables
19090 @section Score Variables
19091 @cindex score variables
19095 @item gnus-use-scoring
19096 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19097 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19098 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19100 @item gnus-kill-killed
19101 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19102 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19103 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19104 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19105 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19106 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19107 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19109 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19110 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19111 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19112 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19113 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19115 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19116 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19117 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19118 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19120 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19121 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19122 @cindex score cache
19123 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19124 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
19125 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19126 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19127 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19128 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19129 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19132 @item gnus-save-score
19133 @vindex gnus-save-score
19134 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19135 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19136 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19138 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19139 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19140 across group visits.
19142 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19143 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19144 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19145 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19146 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19147 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19148 manually entered data.
19150 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19151 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19152 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19154 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19155 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19156 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19157 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19158 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19159 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19161 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19162 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19163 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19164 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19166 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19167 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19168 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19169 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19171 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19172 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19173 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19174 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19176 Predefined functions available are:
19179 @item gnus-score-find-single
19180 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19181 Only apply the group's own score file.
19183 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19184 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19185 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19186 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19187 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19188 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19189 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19190 then a regexp match is done.
19192 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19193 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19195 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19196 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19197 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19198 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19200 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19201 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19202 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19203 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19204 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19208 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19209 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19210 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19211 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19212 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19213 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19214 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19217 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19218 overall score file, you could use the value
19220 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19221 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19224 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19225 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19226 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19227 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19228 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19230 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19231 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19232 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19233 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19234 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19235 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19236 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19237 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19239 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19240 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19241 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19243 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19244 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19245 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19246 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19247 threading---according to the current value of
19248 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19249 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19250 simplified in this manner.
19255 @node Score File Format
19256 @section Score File Format
19257 @cindex score file format
19259 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19260 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19261 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19263 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19267 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19269 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19271 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19273 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19278 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19282 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19283 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19284 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19285 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19289 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19290 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19292 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19293 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19294 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19296 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19301 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19302 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19303 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19304 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19305 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19306 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19307 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19308 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19309 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19310 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19311 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19312 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19313 to articles that matches these score entries.
19315 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19316 score entry has one to four elements.
19320 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19321 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19325 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19326 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19327 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19328 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19329 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19330 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19333 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19334 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19335 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19336 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19337 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19340 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19341 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19342 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19343 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19346 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19347 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19348 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19349 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19350 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19351 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19352 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19353 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19354 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19355 instead, if you feel like.
19358 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19359 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19360 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19361 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19362 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19363 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19367 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19368 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19372 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19373 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19375 These predicates are true if
19378 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19381 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19382 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19389 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19390 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19391 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19392 it's not. I think.)
19394 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19395 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19396 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19397 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19400 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19401 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19402 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19403 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19404 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19405 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19406 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19410 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19411 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19412 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
19413 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
19414 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
19415 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
19416 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
19417 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
19420 @item Head, Body, All
19421 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
19425 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
19426 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
19427 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
19428 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
19429 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
19430 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
19431 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
19435 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
19436 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
19437 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
19438 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
19439 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
19440 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
19441 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
19442 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
19443 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
19444 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
19445 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
19449 @cindex score file atoms
19451 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19452 lower than this number will be marked as read.
19455 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19456 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
19458 @item mark-and-expunge
19459 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19460 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
19463 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
19464 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
19465 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
19466 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
19467 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
19470 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
19471 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
19474 @item exclude-files
19475 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
19476 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
19480 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
19481 ignored when handling global score files.
19484 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
19485 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
19486 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
19487 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
19490 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
19491 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
19492 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
19493 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
19495 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
19499 (mark-and-expunge -100)
19502 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
19503 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
19504 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
19505 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
19506 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
19508 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
19509 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
19510 scoring rules exist.
19513 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
19514 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
19515 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
19516 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
19517 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
19518 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
19519 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19520 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
19521 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
19522 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
19523 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
19527 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
19528 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
19529 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
19530 file for a number of groups.
19533 @cindex local variables
19534 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
19535 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
19536 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
19537 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
19538 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
19543 @node Score File Editing
19544 @section Score File Editing
19546 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
19547 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
19548 with a mode for that.
19550 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
19551 additional commands:
19556 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
19557 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
19558 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
19559 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
19562 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
19563 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
19564 Insert the current date in numerical format
19565 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
19566 you were wondering.
19569 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
19570 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
19571 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
19572 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
19573 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
19578 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
19580 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
19581 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
19583 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
19584 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
19587 @node Adaptive Scoring
19588 @section Adaptive Scoring
19589 @cindex adaptive scoring
19591 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
19592 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
19593 stupidity, to be precise.
19595 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
19596 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
19597 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
19598 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
19599 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19600 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
19601 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
19602 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
19603 variable to @code{(word line)}.
19605 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19606 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
19607 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
19608 might look something like this:
19611 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19612 '((gnus-unread-mark)
19613 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
19614 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
19615 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
19616 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
19617 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
19618 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
19619 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
19620 (gnus-ancient-mark)
19621 (gnus-low-score-mark)
19622 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
19625 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
19626 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
19627 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
19628 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
19629 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
19630 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
19633 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
19634 will be applied to each article.
19636 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
19637 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
19638 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
19639 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
19641 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
19642 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
19643 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
19644 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
19646 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
19647 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
19648 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
19649 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
19651 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
19652 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
19653 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
19654 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
19655 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
19656 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
19658 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
19659 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
19660 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
19662 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
19663 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
19664 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
19666 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
19667 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
19668 let you use different rules in different groups.
19670 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
19671 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
19672 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
19675 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
19676 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
19677 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
19678 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
19679 the length of the match is less than
19680 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
19681 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
19684 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19685 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
19686 headers. If you adapt on words, the
19687 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
19688 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
19691 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19692 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
19693 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
19694 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
19695 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
19698 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
19699 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
19700 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
19701 score with 30 points.
19703 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
19704 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
19705 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
19706 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
19707 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
19709 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
19710 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
19711 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
19712 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
19713 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
19715 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
19716 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
19717 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
19718 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
19720 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
19721 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
19722 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
19723 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
19725 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
19726 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
19727 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
19728 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
19729 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
19731 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
19732 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
19733 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
19735 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
19736 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
19737 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
19738 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
19741 @node Home Score File
19742 @section Home Score File
19744 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
19745 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
19746 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
19747 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
19749 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
19750 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
19751 could perhaps use the same home score file.
19753 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
19754 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
19759 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
19763 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
19764 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
19768 A list. The elements in this list can be:
19772 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
19773 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
19776 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
19777 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
19778 name of the group as the parameter.
19781 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
19784 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
19789 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
19792 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19793 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
19796 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
19797 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
19799 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
19801 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19802 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
19805 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
19806 Other functions include
19809 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
19810 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
19811 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
19812 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
19816 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
19817 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
19818 their own home score files:
19821 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19822 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
19823 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
19824 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
19825 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
19828 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
19829 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
19830 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
19831 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
19832 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
19834 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
19835 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
19836 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
19837 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
19838 precedence over this variable.
19841 @node Followups To Yourself
19842 @section Followups To Yourself
19844 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
19845 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
19846 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
19847 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
19848 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
19849 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
19853 @item gnus-score-followup-article
19854 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
19855 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
19858 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
19859 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
19860 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
19864 @vindex message-sent-hook
19865 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
19866 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
19868 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
19872 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
19873 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
19877 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
19878 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
19881 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
19882 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
19887 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
19891 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
19892 is system-dependent.
19895 @node Scoring On Other Headers
19896 @section Scoring On Other Headers
19897 @cindex scoring on other headers
19899 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
19900 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
19901 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
19902 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
19903 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
19905 Now, there's not much you can do about this for news groups, but for
19906 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
19907 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
19908 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
19909 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
19911 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
19914 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
19915 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
19918 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
19919 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
19920 time if you have much mail.
19922 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
19923 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
19929 @section Scoring Tips
19930 @cindex scoring tips
19936 @cindex scoring crossposts
19937 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
19938 the @code{Xref} header.
19940 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
19943 @item Multiple crossposts
19944 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
19945 more than, say, 3 groups:
19948 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
19952 @item Matching on the body
19953 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
19954 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
19955 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
19956 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
19957 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
19958 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
19959 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
19962 @item Marking as read
19963 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
19964 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
19965 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
19969 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
19971 @item Negated character classes
19972 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
19973 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
19974 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
19978 @node Reverse Scoring
19979 @section Reverse Scoring
19980 @cindex reverse scoring
19982 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
19983 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
19984 like this in your score file:
19988 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
19993 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
19994 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
19997 @node Global Score Files
19998 @section Global Score Files
19999 @cindex global score files
20001 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20002 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20003 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20005 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20006 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20007 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20009 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20010 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20011 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20012 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20013 files are applicable to which group.
20015 To use the score file
20016 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20017 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20021 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20022 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20023 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20026 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20028 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20029 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20030 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20031 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20033 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20034 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20036 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20037 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20038 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20039 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20040 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20041 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20043 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20049 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20051 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20053 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20055 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20056 lowered out of existence.
20058 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20059 articles completely.
20062 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20063 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20064 old articles for a long time.
20067 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20068 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20069 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20070 holding our breath yet?
20074 @section Kill Files
20077 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20078 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20079 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20081 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20082 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20083 files into score files.
20085 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20086 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20087 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20088 that isn't a very good idea.
20090 Normal kill files look like this:
20093 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20094 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20098 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20099 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20101 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20102 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20105 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20110 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20111 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20112 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20115 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20116 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20117 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20120 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20125 @kindex M-k (Group)
20126 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20127 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20130 @kindex M-K (Group)
20131 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20132 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20135 Kill file variables:
20138 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20139 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20140 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20141 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20142 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20143 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20144 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20146 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20147 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20148 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20149 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20152 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20153 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20154 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20155 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20156 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20157 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20158 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20159 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20160 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20162 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20163 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20164 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20169 @node Converting Kill Files
20170 @section Converting Kill Files
20172 @cindex converting kill files
20174 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20175 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20176 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20179 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
20180 You can fetch it from
20181 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20183 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20184 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20185 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20193 @sc{Note:} Unfortunately the GroupLens system seems to have shut down,
20194 so this section is mostly of historical interest.
20196 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/, GroupLens} is a
20197 collaborative filtering system that helps you work together with other
20198 people to find the quality news articles out of the huge volume of
20199 news articles generated every day.
20201 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
20202 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
20203 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
20204 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
20205 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
20206 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
20207 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
20208 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
20212 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
20213 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
20214 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
20215 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
20219 @node Using GroupLens
20220 @subsection Using GroupLens
20222 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local
20223 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html, Better Bit
20224 Bureau (BBB)} is the only better bit in town at the moment.
20226 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
20230 @item gnus-use-grouplens
20231 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
20232 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
20233 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
20235 @item grouplens-pseudonym
20236 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
20237 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
20238 with the Better Bit Bureau.
20240 @item grouplens-newsgroups
20241 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
20242 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
20246 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
20247 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
20248 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
20249 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
20250 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
20251 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
20254 @node Rating Articles
20255 @subsection Rating Articles
20257 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
20258 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
20259 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
20260 yourself is, ``on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
20263 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
20268 @kindex r (GroupLens)
20269 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
20270 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
20273 @kindex k (GroupLens)
20274 @findex grouplens-score-thread
20275 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
20276 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
20277 threads in rec.humor.
20281 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
20282 the score of the article you're reading.
20287 @kindex n (GroupLens)
20288 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
20289 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
20292 @kindex , (GroupLens)
20293 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
20294 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
20298 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
20299 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
20302 @node Displaying Predictions
20303 @subsection Displaying Predictions
20305 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
20306 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
20307 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
20308 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
20309 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
20311 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
20312 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
20313 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
20314 regular Gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
20315 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
20316 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
20317 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
20318 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
20319 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
20320 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
20321 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
20322 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
20323 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
20325 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
20326 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
20327 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
20328 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
20330 The following are valid values for that variable.
20333 @item prediction-spot
20334 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
20337 @item confidence-interval
20338 A numeric confidence interval.
20340 @item prediction-bar
20341 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
20343 @item confidence-bar
20344 Numerical confidence.
20346 @item confidence-spot
20347 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
20349 @item prediction-num
20350 Plain-old numeric value.
20352 @item confidence-plus-minus
20353 Prediction +/- confidence.
20358 @node GroupLens Variables
20359 @subsection GroupLens Variables
20363 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
20364 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
20365 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
20366 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23n%]%)
20369 @item grouplens-bbb-host
20370 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
20373 @item grouplens-bbb-port
20374 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
20376 @item grouplens-score-offset
20377 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
20378 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
20381 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
20382 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
20383 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
20388 @node Advanced Scoring
20389 @section Advanced Scoring
20391 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20392 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20393 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20394 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20395 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20397 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20401 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20402 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20403 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20407 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20408 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20410 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20411 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20412 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20413 non-@code{nil} value.
20415 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20416 operator, and various match operators.
20423 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20424 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20425 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20430 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20431 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20432 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20437 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20438 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20442 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20443 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20444 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20445 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20446 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20447 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20448 the ancestry you want to go.
20450 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20451 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20452 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20453 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20454 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20457 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20458 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20460 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20461 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20464 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20465 when he's talking about Gnus:
20470 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20471 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20478 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20482 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20489 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20490 really don't want to read what he's written:
20494 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20495 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigir Logge")))
20499 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20500 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20501 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20508 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20509 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20510 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20511 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20515 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20516 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20517 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20518 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20521 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20523 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20527 The possibilities are endless.
20529 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20530 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20532 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20533 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20534 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20535 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20536 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20537 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20538 @samp{subject}) first.
20540 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20541 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20552 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20553 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20559 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20566 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20567 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20572 @section Score Decays
20573 @cindex score decays
20576 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20577 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20578 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20579 use them in any sensible way.
20581 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20582 @findex gnus-decay-score
20583 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20584 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20585 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20586 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20587 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20588 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
20589 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
20590 definition of that function:
20593 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20594 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20595 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
20597 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
20599 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
20601 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
20602 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
20603 ;; XEmacs' floor can handle only the floating point
20604 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
20605 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
20607 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
20611 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
20612 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
20613 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
20614 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
20618 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
20621 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
20624 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
20628 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
20629 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
20630 the new score, which should be an integer.
20632 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
20633 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
20638 @include message.texi
20639 @chapter Emacs MIME
20640 @include emacs-mime.texi
20642 @include sieve.texi
20652 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
20653 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
20654 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
20655 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
20656 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
20657 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
20658 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
20659 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
20660 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
20661 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
20662 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
20663 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
20664 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
20665 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
20666 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
20667 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
20668 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
20669 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
20670 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
20671 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
20672 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
20676 @node Process/Prefix
20677 @section Process/Prefix
20678 @cindex process/prefix convention
20680 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
20681 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
20683 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
20684 command to be performed on.
20688 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
20689 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
20690 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
20691 with the current one.
20693 @vindex transient-mark-mode
20694 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
20695 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
20697 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
20698 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
20701 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
20702 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
20704 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
20707 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
20708 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
20709 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
20710 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
20712 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
20713 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
20714 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
20715 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
20716 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
20717 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
20718 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
20719 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
20721 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
20722 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
20723 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
20724 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
20725 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
20729 @section Interactive
20730 @cindex interaction
20734 @item gnus-novice-user
20735 @vindex gnus-novice-user
20736 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
20737 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
20738 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
20739 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
20742 @item gnus-expert-user
20743 @vindex gnus-expert-user
20744 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
20745 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
20746 matter how strange.
20748 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
20749 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
20750 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
20751 is @code{t} by default.
20753 @item gnus-interactive-exit
20754 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
20755 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
20760 @node Symbolic Prefixes
20761 @section Symbolic Prefixes
20762 @cindex symbolic prefixes
20764 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
20765 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
20766 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
20767 rule of 900 to the current article.
20769 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
20770 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
20771 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
20772 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
20773 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
20774 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
20775 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
20777 @kindex M-i (Summary)
20778 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
20779 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
20780 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
20781 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
20782 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
20783 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
20784 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
20785 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
20787 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
20788 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
20789 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
20791 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
20795 @node Formatting Variables
20796 @section Formatting Variables
20797 @cindex formatting variables
20799 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
20800 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
20801 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
20802 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
20803 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
20806 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
20807 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
20808 lots of percentages everywhere.
20811 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
20812 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
20813 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
20814 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
20815 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
20816 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
20817 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
20818 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
20821 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
20822 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
20823 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
20824 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
20825 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
20826 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
20827 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
20828 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
20830 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
20831 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
20833 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
20834 @findex gnus-update-format
20835 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
20836 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
20837 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
20838 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
20842 @node Formatting Basics
20843 @subsection Formatting Basics
20845 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
20846 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
20847 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
20849 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
20850 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
20851 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
20852 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
20853 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
20856 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
20857 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
20858 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
20859 less than 4 characters wide.
20861 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
20862 @samp{%&user-date;}.
20865 @node Mode Line Formatting
20866 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
20868 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
20869 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
20870 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
20871 with the following two differences:
20876 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
20879 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
20880 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
20881 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
20882 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
20883 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
20884 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
20885 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
20890 @node Advanced Formatting
20891 @subsection Advanced Formatting
20893 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
20894 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
20895 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
20896 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
20898 These are the valid modifiers:
20903 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
20907 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
20912 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
20915 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
20920 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
20923 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
20926 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
20929 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
20935 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
20940 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
20941 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
20942 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
20943 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
20944 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
20945 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
20946 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
20948 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
20949 last operation, padding.
20951 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
20952 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
20953 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
20954 @xref{Compilation}.
20957 @node User-Defined Specs
20958 @subsection User-Defined Specs
20960 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
20961 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
20962 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
20963 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
20964 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
20965 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
20966 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
20967 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
20968 should protect against that.
20970 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
20971 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
20973 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
20974 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
20975 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
20976 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
20980 @node Formatting Fonts
20981 @subsection Formatting Fonts
20983 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
20984 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
20985 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
20986 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
20989 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
20990 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
20991 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
20992 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
20993 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
20994 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
20996 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
20997 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
20998 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
20999 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
21000 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
21001 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
21002 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
21003 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
21004 (in GNU Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
21005 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
21006 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
21009 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
21012 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
21013 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
21014 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
21016 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
21017 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
21018 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
21019 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
21020 ;; @r{Set the color.}
21021 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
21022 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
21024 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
21025 (setq gnus-group-line-format
21026 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
21029 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
21030 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
21032 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
21033 mode-line variables.
21035 @node Positioning Point
21036 @subsection Positioning Point
21038 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
21039 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
21040 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
21042 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
21044 @findex gnus-goto-colon
21045 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
21046 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
21048 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
21049 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
21050 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
21055 @subsection Tabulation
21057 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
21058 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
21059 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
21060 about lining up the following text afterwards.
21062 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
21063 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
21065 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21066 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
21067 This is the soft tabulator.
21069 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21070 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
21071 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
21074 @node Wide Characters
21075 @subsection Wide Characters
21077 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
21078 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
21079 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
21081 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
21082 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
21083 these countries, that's not true.
21085 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
21086 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
21087 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
21088 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
21092 @node Window Layout
21093 @section Window Layout
21094 @cindex window layout
21096 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
21098 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
21099 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
21100 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
21101 @code{t} by default.
21103 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
21104 glitches. Use at your own peril.
21106 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
21107 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
21108 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
21111 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
21112 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
21113 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21117 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
21118 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
21119 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
21120 possible names is listed below.
21122 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
21123 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
21126 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21130 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
21131 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
21132 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
21133 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
21134 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
21135 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
21136 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
21137 size spec per split.
21139 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
21140 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
21141 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
21142 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
21143 present) gets focus.
21145 Here's a more complicated example:
21148 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
21149 (summary 0.25 point)
21150 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
21154 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
21155 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
21156 occupy, not a percentage.
21158 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
21159 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
21160 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
21161 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
21162 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
21165 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
21168 (article (horizontal 1.0
21173 (summary 0.25 point)
21178 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
21179 @code{horizontal} thingie?
21181 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
21182 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
21183 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
21184 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
21185 the screen is to be given to this strip.
21187 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
21188 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
21189 lines from the splits.
21191 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
21196 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
21197 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
21198 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
21199 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
21200 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
21201 size = number | frame-params
21202 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
21206 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
21207 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
21208 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
21209 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
21211 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
21212 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
21213 @cindex window height
21214 @cindex window width
21215 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
21216 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
21217 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
21218 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
21219 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
21220 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
21222 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
21223 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
21224 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
21225 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
21227 @findex gnus-configure-frame
21228 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
21229 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
21230 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
21231 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
21232 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
21233 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
21234 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
21235 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
21236 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
21237 configuration list.
21240 (gnus-configure-frame
21244 (article 0.3 point))
21252 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
21253 @code{frame} split:
21256 (gnus-configure-frame
21259 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
21261 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
21262 (user-position . t)
21263 (left . -1) (top . 1))
21268 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
21269 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
21270 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
21271 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
21272 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
21273 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
21274 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
21275 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
21277 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
21278 be found in its default value.
21280 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
21281 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
21282 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
21286 (message (horizontal 1.0
21287 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
21289 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
21294 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
21295 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
21296 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
21301 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
21302 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
21303 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
21304 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
21305 (name . "Message"))
21306 (message 1.0 point))))
21309 @findex gnus-add-configuration
21310 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
21311 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
21312 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
21313 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
21316 (gnus-add-configuration
21317 '(article (vertical 1.0
21319 (summary .25 point)
21323 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
21324 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
21325 Gnus has been loaded.
21327 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
21328 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
21329 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
21330 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
21331 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
21333 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
21334 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
21335 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
21338 @subsection Example Window Configurations
21342 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
21343 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
21358 (gnus-add-configuration
21361 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21363 (summary 0.16 point)
21366 (gnus-add-configuration
21369 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21370 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
21376 @node Faces and Fonts
21377 @section Faces and Fonts
21382 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
21383 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
21384 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
21389 @section Compilation
21390 @cindex compilation
21391 @cindex byte-compilation
21393 @findex gnus-compile
21395 Remember all those line format specification variables?
21396 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
21397 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
21398 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
21399 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
21400 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
21403 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
21404 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
21405 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
21406 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
21407 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
21408 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
21409 them into the @file{~/.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
21413 @section Mode Lines
21416 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
21417 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
21418 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
21419 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
21420 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
21421 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
21422 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
21425 @cindex display-time
21427 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
21428 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
21429 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
21430 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
21431 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
21432 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
21433 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
21434 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
21437 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
21439 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
21440 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
21442 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
21443 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
21444 (length display-time-string)))))
21447 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
21448 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
21449 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
21450 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
21451 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
21454 @node Highlighting and Menus
21455 @section Highlighting and Menus
21457 @cindex highlighting
21460 @vindex gnus-visual
21461 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
21462 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
21463 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
21466 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
21467 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
21470 @item group-highlight
21471 Do highlights in the group buffer.
21472 @item summary-highlight
21473 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
21474 @item article-highlight
21475 Do highlights in the article buffer.
21477 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
21479 Create menus in the group buffer.
21481 Create menus in the summary buffers.
21483 Create menus in the article buffer.
21485 Create menus in the browse buffer.
21487 Create menus in the server buffer.
21489 Create menus in the score buffers.
21491 Create menus in all buffers.
21494 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
21495 buffers, you could say something like:
21498 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
21501 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
21504 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
21507 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
21508 in all Gnus buffers.
21510 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
21513 @item gnus-mouse-face
21514 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
21515 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
21516 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
21520 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
21524 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
21525 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
21526 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
21528 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
21529 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
21530 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
21532 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
21533 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
21534 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
21536 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
21537 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
21538 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
21540 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
21541 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
21542 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
21544 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
21545 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
21546 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
21557 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
21558 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
21559 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
21560 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
21561 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
21565 @vindex gnus-carpal
21566 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
21567 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
21568 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
21573 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21574 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21575 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
21577 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
21578 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
21579 Face used on buttons.
21581 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
21582 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
21583 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
21585 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21586 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21587 Buttons in the group buffer.
21589 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21590 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21591 Buttons in the summary buffer.
21593 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21594 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21595 Buttons in the server buffer.
21597 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21598 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21599 Buttons in the browse buffer.
21602 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
21603 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
21604 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
21612 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
21613 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
21614 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
21615 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
21616 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
21618 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
21619 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
21620 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
21622 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
21623 been idle for thirty minutes:
21626 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
21629 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
21633 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
21636 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
21637 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
21638 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21640 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
21641 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
21642 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
21643 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21645 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
21646 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
21647 @var{idle} minutes.
21649 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
21650 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
21653 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
21654 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
21655 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
21657 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
21658 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
21659 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
21660 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
21662 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
21663 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
21665 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
21667 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
21670 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
21671 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
21672 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
21673 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
21674 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
21675 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
21676 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
21677 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
21678 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
21679 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
21680 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
21682 @findex gnus-demon-init
21683 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
21684 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
21685 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
21686 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
21687 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
21689 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
21690 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
21691 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
21700 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
21701 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
21703 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
21704 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
21705 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
21706 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
21709 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
21710 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
21711 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
21712 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
21714 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
21715 this will make spam disappear.
21717 There are some variables to customize, of course:
21720 @item gnus-use-nocem
21721 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
21722 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
21725 @item gnus-nocem-groups
21726 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
21727 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
21730 ("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
21731 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")
21734 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
21735 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
21736 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
21737 people you want to listen to. The default is
21739 ("Automoose-1" "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca"
21740 "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo" "hweede@@snafu.de")
21742 fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
21744 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at@*
21745 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
21747 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
21748 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
21749 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
21750 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
21751 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
21752 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
21753 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
21754 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
21755 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
21756 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
21758 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
21759 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
21762 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
21765 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
21766 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
21769 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
21772 The specs are applied left-to-right.
21775 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
21776 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
21778 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
21779 says she is. The default is @code{pgg-verify}, which returns
21780 non-@code{nil} if the verification is successful, otherwise (including
21781 the case the NoCeM message was not signed) returns @code{nil}. If this
21782 is too slow and you don't care for verification (which may be dangerous),
21783 you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
21785 Formerly the default was @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
21786 function. While you can still use it, you can change it into
21787 @code{pgg-verify} running with GnuPG if you are willing to add the
21788 @acronym{PGP} public keys to GnuPG's keyring.
21790 @item gnus-nocem-directory
21791 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
21792 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is@*
21793 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
21795 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21796 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21797 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
21798 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
21799 might then see old spam.
21801 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
21802 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
21803 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
21804 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
21805 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
21808 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21809 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21810 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
21811 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
21815 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
21816 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
21817 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
21818 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
21825 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
21826 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
21827 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
21829 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
21830 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
21831 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
21832 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
21833 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
21834 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
21835 @code{undo} function.
21837 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
21838 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
21839 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
21840 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
21841 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
21842 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
21843 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
21844 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
21845 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
21846 never be totally undoable.
21848 @findex gnus-undo-mode
21849 @vindex gnus-use-undo
21851 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
21852 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
21853 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
21854 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
21858 @node Predicate Specifiers
21859 @section Predicate Specifiers
21860 @cindex predicate specifiers
21862 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
21863 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
21864 to type all that much.
21866 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
21871 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
21872 gnus-article-unread-p)
21875 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
21876 functions all take one parameter.
21878 @findex gnus-make-predicate
21879 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
21880 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
21881 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
21886 @section Moderation
21889 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
21890 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
21891 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
21894 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
21898 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
21901 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
21903 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
21908 You split your incoming mail by matching on
21909 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
21910 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
21913 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
21914 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
21917 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
21918 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
21922 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
21925 (setq gnus-moderated-list
21926 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
21930 @node Fetching a Group
21931 @section Fetching a Group
21932 @cindex fetching a group
21934 @findex gnus-fetch-group
21935 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
21936 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
21937 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
21938 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
21939 It takes the group name as a parameter.
21942 @node Image Enhancements
21943 @section Image Enhancements
21945 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
21946 support images yet.}, is able to display pictures and stuff, so Gnus has
21947 taken advantage of that.
21950 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
21951 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
21952 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
21953 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
21954 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
21962 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
21963 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
21964 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
21968 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
21969 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
21970 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
21978 Decoding an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
21979 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions has), or that you
21980 have @samp{compface} installed on your system. If either is true,
21981 Gnus will default to displaying @code{X-Face} headers.
21983 The variable that controls this is the
21984 @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} variable. If this variable is a
21985 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
21986 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
21987 If the @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches
21988 the @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
21990 The default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
21991 @code{display} program@footnote{@code{display} is from the ImageMagick
21992 package. For the @code{uncompface} and @code{icontopbm} programs look
21993 for a package like @code{compface} or @code{faces-xface} on a GNU/Linux
21994 system.} to view the face.
21996 Under XEmacs or Emacs 21+ with suitable image support, the default
21997 action is to display the face before the @code{From} header. (It's
21998 nicer if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support---that
21999 will make display somewhat faster. If there's no native @code{X-Face}
22000 support, Gnus will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using
22001 external programs from the @code{pbmplus} package and
22002 friends.@footnote{On a GNU/Linux system look for packages with names
22003 like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.})
22005 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
22013 @vindex gnus-x-face
22014 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
22015 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
22016 default colors are black and white.
22019 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
22020 easier insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages.
22022 @findex gnus-random-x-face
22023 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
22024 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
22025 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
22026 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
22027 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
22028 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
22029 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
22030 header data as a string.
22032 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
22033 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
22034 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
22035 randomly generated data.
22037 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
22038 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
22039 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
22040 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
22041 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
22043 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
22044 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22047 (setq message-required-news-headers
22048 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22049 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
22052 Using the last function would be something like this:
22055 (setq message-required-news-headers
22056 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22057 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
22058 (gnus-x-face-from-file
22059 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
22067 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces'implementations should really be harmonized.
22069 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
22070 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
22071 represent the author of the message.
22074 @findex gnus-article-display-face
22075 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
22076 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
22079 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
22080 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
22082 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
22083 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
22084 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
22086 @findex gnus-face-from-file
22087 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
22088 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
22089 converts the file to Face format by using the
22090 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
22092 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
22093 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22096 (setq message-required-news-headers
22097 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22098 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
22099 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
22104 @subsection Smileys
22109 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
22114 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
22115 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
22117 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
22118 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22121 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
22124 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
22125 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
22126 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
22127 text and maps that to file names.
22129 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
22130 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
22131 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
22132 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
22133 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
22136 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
22141 @item smiley-data-directory
22142 @vindex smiley-data-directory
22143 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
22145 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
22146 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
22147 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
22161 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
22162 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
22163 over your shoulder as you read news.
22165 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
22174 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
22175 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
22176 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
22177 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
22178 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
22179 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
22180 @code{GIF} formats.
22183 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22184 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
22185 point your Web browser at
22186 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
22188 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
22189 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
22191 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
22192 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
22195 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
22199 @item gnus-picon-databases
22200 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22201 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
22202 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
22203 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
22204 "/usr/local/faces")}.
22206 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
22207 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
22208 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22209 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
22211 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
22212 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
22213 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
22214 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
22216 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
22217 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
22218 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22219 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
22220 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
22222 @item gnus-picon-file-types
22223 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
22224 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
22225 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
22231 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
22234 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22235 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22236 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
22237 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
22238 unusual directory structure.
22240 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22241 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22242 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
22247 @subsubsection Toolbar
22251 @item gnus-use-toolbar
22252 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
22253 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
22254 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-nil, it should be one
22255 of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom}, @code{right},
22256 and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default toolbar, the
22257 rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those names show.
22258 The default is @code{default}.
22260 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
22261 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
22262 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
22263 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
22264 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
22265 The default is that of the default toolbar.
22267 @item gnus-group-toolbar
22268 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
22269 The toolbar in the group buffer.
22271 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
22272 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
22273 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
22275 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22276 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22277 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
22288 @node Fuzzy Matching
22289 @section Fuzzy Matching
22290 @cindex fuzzy matching
22292 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
22293 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
22295 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
22296 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
22297 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
22299 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
22300 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
22301 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
22302 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
22303 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
22306 @node Thwarting Email Spam
22307 @section Thwarting Email Spam
22311 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22313 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
22314 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
22315 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
22316 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
22317 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
22318 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
22319 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
22320 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
22323 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
22324 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
22325 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
22326 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
22327 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
22328 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
22330 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
22333 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
22334 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
22335 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
22336 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
22337 * Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package::
22338 * Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat::
22341 @node The problem of spam
22342 @subsection The problem of spam
22344 @cindex spam filtering approaches
22345 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
22347 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22349 First, some background on spam.
22351 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
22352 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
22353 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
22354 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
22355 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
22356 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
22357 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
22358 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
22359 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
22361 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
22362 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
22363 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
22364 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
22365 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
22366 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
22367 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
22368 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
22369 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
22372 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
22373 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
22374 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
22375 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
22376 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
22377 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
22378 from Bulgarian IPs.
22380 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
22381 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
22382 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
22383 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
22385 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
22386 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
22387 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
22388 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
22390 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
22391 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
22392 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
22393 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
22394 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
22395 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
22396 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
22397 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
22398 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
22400 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
22401 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
22402 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
22403 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
22404 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
22405 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
22406 down for some time because of the incident.
22408 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
22409 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
22410 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
22411 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
22412 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
22413 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
22414 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
22415 to store the database of spam analyses. Statistical analysis on the
22416 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
22417 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
22418 the server that it has misclassified mail.
22420 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
22421 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
22422 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
22423 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
22424 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
22425 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
22426 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
22429 @node Anti-Spam Basics
22430 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
22434 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22436 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
22437 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
22439 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
22440 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
22441 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
22442 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
22443 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
22444 part of the mail address.)
22447 (setq message-default-news-headers
22448 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
22451 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
22452 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22456 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
22457 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
22458 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
22463 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
22464 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
22465 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
22466 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
22468 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
22469 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
22470 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
22471 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
22472 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
22473 your fancy split rule in this way:
22478 (to "larsi" "misc")
22482 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
22483 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
22484 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
22485 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
22486 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
22488 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
22489 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
22490 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
22491 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
22493 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
22497 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
22498 @cindex SpamAssassin
22499 @cindex Vipul's Razor
22502 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
22503 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
22504 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
22505 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
22506 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
22507 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
22508 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
22510 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
22511 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
22512 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
22515 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
22516 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
22517 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
22518 Specifiers}) follow.
22522 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
22526 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
22529 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
22530 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
22531 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
22534 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
22538 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22541 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
22542 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
22546 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
22547 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
22548 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
22549 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
22552 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
22554 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
22558 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
22559 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
22563 Note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will not be
22564 downloaded by default. You need to set
22565 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
22566 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
22568 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
22569 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
22570 spam. And here is the nifty function:
22573 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
22574 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
22576 (gnus-summary-show-raw-article)
22577 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d")
22578 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
22582 @subsection Hashcash
22585 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
22586 costly for each message they send. This has the obvious drawback that
22587 you cannot rely on everyone in the world using this technique,
22588 since it is not part of the Internet standards, but it may be useful
22589 in smaller communities.
22591 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
22592 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
22593 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
22594 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
22595 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
22596 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
22597 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
22598 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
22599 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
22600 one of them separately.
22603 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
22604 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
22605 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:}
22606 header. For more details, and for the external application
22607 @code{hashcash} you need to install to use this feature, see
22608 @uref{http://www.cypherspace.org/~adam/hashcash/}. Even more
22609 information can be found at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
22611 If you wish to call hashcash for each message you send, say something
22615 (require 'hashcash)
22616 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'mail-add-payment)
22619 The @file{hashcash.el} library can be found in the Gnus development
22620 contrib directory or at
22621 @uref{http://users.actrix.gen.nz/mycroft/hashcash.el}.
22623 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
22627 @item hashcash-default-payment
22628 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
22629 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
22630 should consist of. By default this is 0, meaning nothing will be
22631 done. Suggested useful values include 17 to 29.
22633 @item hashcash-payment-alist
22634 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
22635 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
22636 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
22637 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
22638 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
22639 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
22640 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
22641 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
22645 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed.
22649 Currently there is no built in functionality in Gnus to verify
22650 hashcash cookies, it is expected that this is performed by your hand
22651 customized mail filtering scripts. Improvements in this area would be
22652 a useful contribution, however.
22654 @node Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
22655 @subsection Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
22656 @cindex spam filtering
22659 The idea behind @file{spam.el} is to have a control center for spam detection
22660 and filtering in Gnus. To that end, @file{spam.el} does two things: it
22661 filters new mail, and it analyzes mail known to be spam or ham.
22662 @dfn{Ham} is the name used throughout @file{spam.el} to indicate
22665 @cindex spam-initialize
22666 First of all, you @strong{must} run the function
22667 @code{spam-initialize} to autoload @code{spam.el} and to install the
22668 @code{spam.el} hooks. There is one exception: if you use the
22669 @code{spam-use-stat} (@pxref{spam-stat spam filtering}) setting, you
22670 should turn it on before @code{spam-initialize}:
22673 (setq spam-use-stat t) ;; if needed
22677 So, what happens when you load @file{spam.el}?
22679 First, some hooks will get installed by @code{spam-initialize}. There
22680 are some hooks for @code{spam-stat} so it can save its databases, and
22681 there are hooks so interesting things will happen when you enter and
22682 leave a group. More on the sequence of events later (@pxref{Spam
22683 ELisp Package Sequence of Events}).
22685 You get the following keyboard commands:
22695 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
22696 @code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}.
22698 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark.
22699 Whenever you see a spam article, make sure to mark its summary line
22700 with @kbd{M-d} before leaving the group. This is done automatically
22701 for unread articles in @emph{spam} groups.
22707 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
22708 @code{spam-bogofilter-score}.
22710 You must have Bogofilter installed for that command to work properly.
22716 Also, when you load @file{spam.el}, you will be able to customize its
22717 variables. Try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{spam} variable
22721 * Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events::
22722 * Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail::
22723 * Spam ELisp Package Global Variables::
22724 * Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples::
22725 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
22726 * BBDB Whitelists::
22727 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
22728 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
22730 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
22732 * ifile spam filtering::
22733 * spam-stat spam filtering::
22735 * Extending the Spam ELisp package::
22738 @node Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events
22739 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events
22740 @cindex spam filtering
22741 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
22744 You must read this section to understand how @code{spam.el} works.
22745 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
22747 There are two @emph{contact points}, if you will, between
22748 @code{spam.el} and the rest of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and
22751 Getting new mail is done in one of two ways. You can either split
22752 your incoming mail or you can classify new articles as ham or spam
22753 when you enter the group.
22755 Splitting incoming mail is better suited to mail backends such as
22756 @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap} where new mail appears in a single file
22757 called a @dfn{Spool File}. See @xref{Spam ELisp Package Filtering of
22760 For backends such as @code{nntp} there is no incoming mail spool, so
22761 an alternate mechanism must be used. This may also happen for
22762 backends where the server is in charge of splitting incoming mail, and
22763 Gnus does not do further splitting. The @code{spam-autodetect} and
22764 @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameters (accessible with
22765 @kbd{G c} and @kbd{G p} as usual), and the corresponding variables
22766 @code{gnus-spam-autodetect-methods} and
22767 @code{gnus-spam-autodetect-methods} (accessible with @kbd{M-x
22768 customize-variable} as usual).
22770 When @code{spam-autodetect} is used, it hooks into the process of
22771 entering a group. Thus, entering a group with unseen or unread
22772 articles becomes the substitute for checking incoming mail. Whether
22773 only unseen articles or all unread articles will be processed is
22774 determined by the @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages}. When set
22775 to @code{t}, unread messages will be rechecked.
22777 @code{spam-autodetect} grants the user at once more and less control
22778 of spam filtering. The user will have more control over each group's
22779 spam methods, so for instance the @samp{ding} group may have
22780 @code{spam-use-BBDB} as the autodetection method, while the
22781 @samp{suspect} group may have the @code{spam-use-blacklist} and
22782 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods enabled. Every article detected to
22783 be spam will be marked with the spam mark @samp{$} and processed on
22784 exit from the group as normal spam. The user has less control over
22785 the @emph{sequence} of checks, as he might with @code{spam-split}.
22787 When the newly split mail goes into groups, or messages are
22788 autodetected to be ham or spam, those groups must be exited (after
22789 entering, if needed) for further spam processing to happen. It
22790 matters whether the group is considered a ham group, a spam group, or
22791 is unclassified, based on its @code{spam-content} parameter
22792 (@pxref{Spam ELisp Package Global Variables}). Spam groups have the
22793 additional characteristic that, when entered, any unseen or unread
22794 articles (depending on the @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam}
22795 variable) will be marked as spam. Thus, mail split into a spam group
22796 gets automatically marked as spam when you enter the group.
22798 So, when you exit a group, the @code{spam-processors} are applied, if
22799 any are set, and the processed mail is moved to the
22800 @code{ham-process-destination} or the @code{spam-process-destination}
22801 depending on the article's classification. If the
22802 @code{ham-process-destination} or the @code{spam-process-destination},
22803 whichever is appropriate, are @code{nil}, the article is left in the
22806 If a spam is found in any group (this can be changed to only non-spam
22807 groups with @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only}), it is
22808 processed by the active @code{spam-processors} (@pxref{Spam ELisp
22809 Package Global Variables}) when the group is exited. Furthermore, the
22810 spam is moved to the @code{spam-process-destination} (@pxref{Spam
22811 ELisp Package Global Variables}) for further training or deletion.
22812 You have to load the @code{gnus-registry.el} package and enable the
22813 @code{spam-log-to-registry} variable if you want spam to be processed
22814 no more than once. Thus, spam is detected and processed everywhere,
22815 which is what most people want. If the
22816 @code{spam-process-destination} is @code{nil}, the spam is marked as
22817 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
22819 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
22820 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
22822 If a ham mail is found in a ham group, as determined by the
22823 @code{ham-marks} parameter, it is processed as ham by the active ham
22824 @code{spam-processor} when the group is exited. With the variables
22825 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
22826 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} the behavior can be further
22827 altered so ham found anywhere can be processed. You have to load the
22828 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and enable the
22829 @code{spam-log-to-registry} variable if you want ham to be processed
22830 no more than once. Thus, ham is detected and processed only when
22831 necessary, which is what most people want. More on this in
22832 @xref{Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples}.
22834 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
22835 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
22837 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
22838 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
22839 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
22841 @node Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail
22842 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail
22843 @cindex spam filtering
22844 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
22847 To use the @file{spam.el} facilities for incoming mail filtering, you
22848 must add the following to your fancy split list
22849 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}:
22855 Note that the fancy split may be called @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
22856 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on whether you use the nnmail or
22857 nnimap back ends to retrieve your mail.
22859 Also, @code{spam-split} will not modify incoming mail in any way.
22861 The @code{spam-split} function will process incoming mail and send the
22862 mail considered to be spam into the group name given by the variable
22863 @code{spam-split-group}. By default that group name is @samp{spam},
22864 but you can customize @code{spam-split-group}. Make sure the contents
22865 of @code{spam-split-group} are an @emph{unqualified} group name, for
22866 instance in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server} the value
22867 @samp{spam} will turn out to be @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The
22868 value @samp{nnimap+server:spam}, therefore, is wrong and will
22869 actually give you the group
22870 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam} which may or may not
22871 work depending on your server's tolerance for strange group names.
22873 You can also give @code{spam-split} a parameter,
22874 e.g. @code{spam-use-regex-headers} or @code{"maybe-spam"}. Why is
22877 Take these split rules (with @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and
22878 @code{spam-use-blackholes} set):
22881 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
22882 (any "ding" "ding")
22884 ;; @r{default mailbox}
22888 Now, the problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the
22889 ding folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam
22890 detected by SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through,
22891 when it's sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to
22892 the ding list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the
22893 invocation of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
22895 You can let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, but all other
22896 @code{spam-split} rules (including a second invocation of the
22897 regex-headers check) will be after the ding rule:
22902 ;; @r{all spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
22903 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
22904 (any "ding" "ding")
22905 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
22907 ;; @r{default mailbox}
22911 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
22912 your particular needs, and to target the results of those checks to a
22913 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
22914 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
22915 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
22916 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
22917 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
22919 You should still have specific checks such as
22920 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} set to @code{t}, even if you
22921 specifically invoke @code{spam-split} with the check. The reason is
22922 that when loading @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done
22923 depending on what @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. This
22924 is usually not critical, though.
22926 @emph{Note for IMAP users}
22928 The boolean variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} needs to be
22929 set, if you want to split based on the whole message instead of just
22930 the headers. By default, the nnimap back end will only retrieve the
22931 message headers. If you use @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
22932 @code{spam-check-ifile}, or @code{spam-check-stat} (the splitters that
22933 can benefit from the full message body), you should set this variable.
22934 It is not set by default because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and
22935 that is not an appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user.
22937 @xref{Splitting in IMAP}.
22939 @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
22940 statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
22943 @node Spam ELisp Package Global Variables
22944 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Global Variables
22945 @cindex spam filtering
22946 @cindex spam filtering variables
22947 @cindex spam variables
22950 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
22951 The concepts of ham processors and spam processors are very important.
22952 Ham processors and spam processors for a group can be set with the
22953 @code{spam-process} group parameter, or the
22954 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. Ham processors take
22955 mail known to be non-spam (@emph{ham}) and process it in some way so
22956 that later similar mail will also be considered non-spam. Spam
22957 processors take mail known to be spam and process it so similar spam
22958 will be detected later.
22960 The format of the spam or ham processor entry used to be a symbol,
22961 but now it is a @sc{cons} cell. See the individual spam processor entries
22962 for more information.
22964 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
22965 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
22966 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
22967 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
22968 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
22969 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
22970 by customizing the corresponding variable
22971 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
22972 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
22973 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
22974 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
22975 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
22976 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
22977 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
22980 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
22982 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
22983 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
22984 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
22985 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
22986 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
22987 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
22988 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
22989 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
22990 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
22991 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
22992 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
22993 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
22994 processor which will study them as spam samples.
22996 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
22997 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
22998 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
22999 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
23000 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
23001 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
23002 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
23003 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
23006 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23007 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
23008 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
23009 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
23010 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
23011 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
23012 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
23017 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23018 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
23019 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
23020 you really want to.
23023 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
23024 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
23025 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
23026 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
23027 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
23028 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
23031 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
23032 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
23033 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
23034 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
23035 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
23036 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
23037 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
23038 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
23039 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
23040 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
23041 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
23042 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
23043 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
23044 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
23045 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
23047 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23048 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23050 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23051 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
23052 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
23054 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
23055 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
23057 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
23058 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
23059 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
23060 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
23061 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
23063 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
23064 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
23065 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
23066 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
23067 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
23070 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23071 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
23072 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
23073 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
23074 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
23075 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
23076 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
23077 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
23078 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
23079 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
23080 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
23081 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
23082 group buffer then you need it here as well.
23084 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23085 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23087 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23088 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
23091 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
23092 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
23093 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
23094 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
23095 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
23096 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
23097 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
23099 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
23100 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
23101 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
23102 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
23104 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
23105 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
23106 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
23107 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
23108 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
23109 from the mail server.
23111 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
23112 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
23113 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
23114 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
23116 @node Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples
23117 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples
23118 @cindex spam filtering
23119 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
23120 @cindex spam configuration examples
23123 @subsubheading Ted's setup
23125 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
23127 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
23128 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
23129 (gnus-registry-initialize)
23132 ;; @r{I like @kbd{C-s} for marking spam}
23133 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map "\C-s" 'gnus-summary-mark-as-spam)
23136 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
23138 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
23139 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
23140 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23141 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23142 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
23143 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
23144 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
23145 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
23146 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23147 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
23148 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23149 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
23150 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
23151 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
23152 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23153 (any "ding" "ding")
23154 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
23156 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23159 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
23161 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
23162 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
23163 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
23164 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
23166 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23168 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
23169 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
23170 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
23171 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
23172 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23174 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
23175 ((spam-autodetect . t))
23177 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
23179 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
23180 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
23182 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
23183 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
23184 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
23186 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
23188 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
23189 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
23191 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
23192 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
23193 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
23195 (gnus-ticked-mark))
23196 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
23197 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
23198 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
23200 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
23201 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
23202 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
23206 @subsubheading Using @file{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
23207 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23209 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
23210 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
23211 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
23212 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
23213 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
23214 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
23215 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
23216 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
23217 @samp{training.spam} folders.
23219 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
23220 does most of the job for me:
23223 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
23224 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
23225 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
23226 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23227 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
23228 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
23229 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
23234 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
23236 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
23237 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
23238 bogofilter or DCC).
23240 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
23241 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
23242 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark (@code{ham-marks},
23243 @ref{Spam ELisp Package Global Variables}). On group exit, those
23244 messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want to have
23245 the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter) and
23246 deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
23248 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
23249 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
23250 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
23251 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
23252 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
23253 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
23255 @item @b{Ham folders:}
23257 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
23258 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
23259 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
23260 @samp{training.ham}.
23263 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
23265 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23267 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
23268 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
23269 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
23273 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
23276 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
23277 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
23278 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
23279 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
23280 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
23282 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
23283 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
23284 @cindex spam filtering
23285 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
23286 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
23289 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
23291 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
23292 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
23293 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
23294 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
23299 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
23301 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
23302 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
23303 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23304 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
23305 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23309 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
23311 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
23312 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23313 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
23317 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
23319 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23320 customizing the group parameters or the
23321 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23322 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23323 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
23327 Instead of the obsolete
23328 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
23329 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
23330 the same way, we promise.
23334 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
23336 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23337 customizing the group parameters or the
23338 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23339 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23340 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23341 whitelist. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23342 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23346 Instead of the obsolete
23347 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
23348 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
23349 the same way, we promise.
23353 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
23354 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
23355 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
23356 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
23357 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
23359 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
23360 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
23361 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
23362 Emacs regular expression syntax.
23364 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
23365 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
23366 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
23367 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
23368 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
23369 @file{blacklist} respectively.
23371 @node BBDB Whitelists
23372 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
23373 @cindex spam filtering
23374 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
23375 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
23378 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
23380 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23381 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
23382 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
23383 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
23384 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23385 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
23386 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23390 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
23392 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
23393 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23394 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
23395 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
23396 classified as spammers.
23400 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
23402 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23403 customizing the group parameters or the
23404 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23405 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23406 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23407 BBDB. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23408 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23412 Instead of the obsolete
23413 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
23414 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
23415 the same way, we promise.
23419 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
23420 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
23421 @cindex spam reporting
23422 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23423 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23426 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
23428 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23429 customizing the group parameters or the
23430 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23431 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23432 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
23435 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
23439 Instead of the obsolete
23440 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
23441 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
23442 same way, we promise.
23446 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
23448 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
23449 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
23450 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
23451 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
23452 @code{spam-report.el} will use the @code{X-Report-Spam} header that
23457 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23458 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23459 @cindex spam filtering
23460 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
23463 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
23465 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23466 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
23467 instead of the sender address. You must have the @code{hashcash.el}
23468 package loaded for @code{spam-use-hashcash} to work properly.
23469 Messages without a hashcash payment token will be sent to the next
23470 spam-split rule. This is an explicit filter, meaning that unless a
23471 hashcash token is found, the messages are not assumed to be spam or
23477 @subsubsection Blackholes
23478 @cindex spam filtering
23479 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
23482 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
23484 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
23485 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
23486 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
23487 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
23488 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
23489 contains outdated servers.
23491 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
23492 @file{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
23493 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
23494 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
23495 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
23496 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
23500 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
23502 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
23506 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
23508 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
23509 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
23513 @defvar spam-use-dig
23515 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
23516 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
23520 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
23521 ham processor for blackholes.
23523 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
23524 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
23525 @cindex spam filtering
23526 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
23529 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
23531 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
23532 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
23533 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
23534 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
23535 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
23536 message is spam or ham, respectively.
23540 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
23542 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23543 the message, positively identify it as spam.
23547 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
23549 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23550 the message, positively identify it as ham.
23554 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
23555 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
23558 @subsubsection Bogofilter
23559 @cindex spam filtering
23560 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
23563 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
23565 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23568 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
23569 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
23570 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
23571 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
23572 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
23573 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
23575 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
23576 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
23579 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
23580 processing will be turned off.
23582 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
23586 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
23588 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23589 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
23590 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
23591 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
23592 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
23593 installation documents for details.
23595 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
23599 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
23600 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23601 customizing the group parameters or the
23602 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23603 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
23604 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
23608 Instead of the obsolete
23609 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23610 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23611 the same way, we promise.
23614 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
23615 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23616 customizing the group parameters or the
23617 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23618 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23619 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
23620 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23621 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23625 Instead of the obsolete
23626 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23627 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23628 the same way, we promise.
23631 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
23633 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
23634 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
23635 database directory.
23639 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
23640 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23641 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
23642 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
23643 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
23644 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
23646 @node ifile spam filtering
23647 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
23648 @cindex spam filtering
23649 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
23652 @defvar spam-use-ifile
23654 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
23655 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
23659 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
23661 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
23662 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
23663 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
23667 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
23669 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
23670 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
23671 the default value of @samp{spam}.
23674 @defvar spam-ifile-database-path
23676 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
23677 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
23681 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
23682 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23683 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
23684 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
23687 @node spam-stat spam filtering
23688 @subsubsection spam-stat spam filtering
23689 @cindex spam filtering
23690 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
23694 @xref{Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat}.
23696 @defvar spam-use-stat
23698 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use
23699 spam-stat.el, an Emacs Lisp statistical analyzer.
23703 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
23704 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23705 customizing the group parameters or the
23706 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23707 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23708 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
23712 Instead of the obsolete
23713 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23714 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23715 the same way, we promise.
23718 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
23719 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23720 customizing the group parameters or the
23721 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23722 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23723 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
23724 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23725 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23729 Instead of the obsolete
23730 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23731 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23732 the same way, we promise.
23735 This enables @file{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
23736 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
23737 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
23738 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
23739 @code{spam-split} are provided.
23742 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
23743 @cindex spam filtering
23747 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
23748 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
23749 installed separately.
23751 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
23752 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
23753 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
23754 mail as a spam mail or not.
23756 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
23757 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
23758 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
23760 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Filtering Spam
23761 Using The Spam ELisp Package}) call SpamOracle.
23763 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
23764 To enable SpamOracle usage by @file{spam.el}, set the variable
23765 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
23766 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy} as described in
23767 the section @xref{Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package}. In
23768 this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is filtered using
23769 SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be moved to
23770 @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham messages stay
23774 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
23775 spam-split-group "Junk"
23776 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
23777 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23778 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
23781 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
23782 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
23786 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
23787 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
23788 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
23792 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
23793 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
23794 store its analyses. This is controlled by the variable
23795 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
23796 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
23797 database to live somewhere special, set
23798 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
23801 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
23802 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
23803 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns the
23804 characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
23805 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
23806 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary buffer
23807 and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using @file{spam.el}'s
23808 spam- and ham-processors, which is much more convenient. For a
23809 detailed description of spam- and ham-processors, @xref{Filtering Spam
23810 Using The Spam ELisp Package}.
23812 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
23813 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23814 customizing the group parameter or the
23815 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
23816 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
23817 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
23821 Instead of the obsolete
23822 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
23823 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
23824 the same way, we promise.
23827 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
23828 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23829 customizing the group parameter or the
23830 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
23831 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
23832 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
23833 messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam} or
23834 @emph{unclassified} groups.
23838 Instead of the obsolete
23839 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
23840 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
23841 the same way, we promise.
23844 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
23845 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
23848 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
23849 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
23850 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
23852 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
23853 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
23854 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
23855 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
23856 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
23857 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
23859 @node Extending the Spam ELisp package
23860 @subsubsection Extending the Spam ELisp package
23861 @cindex spam filtering
23862 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
23863 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
23865 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
23866 incoming mail, provide the following:
23874 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
23875 "True if blackbox should be used.")
23880 (spam-use-blackbox . spam-check-blackbox)
23882 to @code{spam-list-of-checks}.
23886 (gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox ham spam-use-blackbox)
23887 (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox spam spam-use-blackbox)
23890 to @code{spam-list-of-processors}.
23894 (spam-use-blackbox spam-blackbox-register-routine
23896 spam-blackbox-unregister-routine
23900 to @code{spam-registration-functions}. Write the register/unregister
23901 routines using the bogofilter register/unregister routines as a
23902 start, or other restister/unregister routines more appropriate to
23908 Write the @code{spam-check-blackbox} function. It should return
23909 @samp{nil} or @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other
23910 conventions. See the existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for
23911 examples of what you can do, and stick to the template unless you
23912 fully understand the reasons why you aren't.
23914 Make sure to add @code{spam-use-blackbox} to
23915 @code{spam-list-of-statistical-checks} if Blackbox is a statistical
23916 mail analyzer that needs the full message body to operate.
23920 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
23927 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
23928 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
23930 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
23931 variables. Instead the form @code{'(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
23932 @code{'(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
23933 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
23936 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
23937 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
23938 Only applicable to spam groups.")
23940 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
23941 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
23942 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
23951 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
23952 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
23954 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
23955 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
23956 variable customization.
23960 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
23962 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
23968 @node Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
23969 @subsection Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
23970 @cindex Paul Graham
23971 @cindex Graham, Paul
23972 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
23973 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
23974 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
23976 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
23977 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
23978 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
23979 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
23980 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
23981 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
23982 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
23983 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
23984 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
23987 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
23988 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
23989 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
23990 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
23991 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
23992 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
23993 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
23994 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
23996 Gnus supports this kind of filtering. But it needs some setting up.
23997 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
23998 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
23999 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
24000 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
24003 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
24004 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
24005 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
24008 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24009 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24011 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
24012 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
24013 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
24014 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
24015 need several hundred emails in both collections.
24017 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
24018 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
24019 per mail. Use the following:
24021 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
24022 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
24023 is treated as one spam mail.
24026 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
24027 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
24028 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
24031 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
24032 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds
24033 the the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
24034 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
24035 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds the the group
24036 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
24038 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
24039 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
24040 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
24041 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
24042 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
24045 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
24046 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
24047 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
24048 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
24051 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
24052 reset the dictionary.
24054 @defun spam-stat-reset
24055 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
24058 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
24059 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
24060 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
24061 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
24062 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
24063 only non-spam mails.
24065 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
24066 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
24067 to update the dictionary incrementally.
24070 @defun spam-stat-save
24071 Save the dictionary.
24074 @defvar spam-stat-file
24075 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
24076 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
24079 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
24080 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
24082 In order to use @code{spam-stat} to split your mail, you need to add the
24083 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24086 (require 'spam-stat)
24090 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
24093 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
24094 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
24095 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
24096 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
24098 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
24099 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
24100 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
24101 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
24104 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24105 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24109 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
24110 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
24113 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
24114 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
24115 expression are considered potential spam.
24118 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24119 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24120 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24124 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
24125 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
24126 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
24127 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
24128 mails, when creating the dictionary!
24131 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24132 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24133 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24137 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
24138 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
24139 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
24140 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
24141 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
24145 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24146 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
24147 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24148 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24153 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24154 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24156 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
24158 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
24159 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
24160 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24163 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
24164 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
24165 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24168 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
24169 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
24170 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
24171 already been processed as non-spam.
24174 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
24175 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
24176 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
24177 been processed as spam.
24180 @defun spam-stat-save
24181 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
24182 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24185 @defun spam-stat-load
24186 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
24187 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24190 @defun spam-stat-score-word
24191 Return the spam score for a word.
24194 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
24195 Return the spam score for a buffer.
24198 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
24199 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
24200 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
24203 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
24204 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24207 (require 'spam-stat)
24211 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
24214 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24215 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24216 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24217 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24218 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24219 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24220 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24221 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24222 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24223 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24224 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24225 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24226 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24227 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24230 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
24233 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24234 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24235 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24236 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
24237 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24238 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24242 @section Interaction with other modes
24247 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provided some useful functions for dired
24248 buffers. It is enabled with
24250 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
24255 @findex gnus-dired-attach
24256 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
24257 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
24260 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
24261 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
24262 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
24266 @findex gnus-dired-print
24267 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
24268 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
24271 @node Various Various
24272 @section Various Various
24278 @item gnus-home-directory
24279 @vindex gnus-home-directory
24280 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
24281 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
24283 @item gnus-directory
24284 @vindex gnus-directory
24285 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
24286 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
24287 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
24289 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
24290 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
24291 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
24292 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
24294 @item gnus-default-directory
24295 @vindex gnus-default-directory
24296 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
24297 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
24298 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
24299 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
24300 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
24301 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
24304 @vindex gnus-verbose
24305 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
24306 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
24307 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
24308 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
24309 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
24311 @item gnus-verbose-backends
24312 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
24313 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
24314 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
24316 @item nnheader-max-head-length
24317 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
24318 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
24319 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
24320 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
24321 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
24322 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
24323 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
24324 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
24325 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
24327 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
24328 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
24329 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
24330 read when doing the operation described above.
24332 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24333 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24335 @cindex invalid characters in file names
24336 @cindex characters in file names
24337 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
24338 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
24339 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
24343 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24348 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
24349 Windows (phooey) systems.
24351 @item gnus-hidden-properties
24352 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
24353 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
24354 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
24355 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
24357 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
24358 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
24359 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
24360 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
24361 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
24363 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
24364 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
24365 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
24367 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24368 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24370 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
24371 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
24372 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
24373 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
24376 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
24384 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
24385 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
24387 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
24389 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
24395 Not because of victories @*
24398 but for the common sunshine,@*
24400 the largess of the spring.
24404 but for the day's work done@*
24405 as well as I was able;@*
24406 not for a seat upon the dais@*
24407 but at the common table.@*
24412 @chapter Appendices
24415 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
24416 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
24417 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
24418 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
24419 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
24420 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
24421 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
24422 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
24423 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
24430 @cindex installing under XEmacs
24432 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
24433 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
24434 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
24435 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
24436 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
24437 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
24444 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
24445 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
24447 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
24448 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
24449 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
24450 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
24451 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
24453 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
24454 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
24455 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
24456 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
24457 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
24458 appropriate name, don't you think?)
24460 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
24461 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
24462 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
24463 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
24466 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
24467 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
24468 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
24469 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
24470 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
24471 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
24472 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
24473 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
24474 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
24478 @node Gnus Versions
24479 @subsection Gnus Versions
24481 @cindex September Gnus
24483 @cindex Quassia Gnus
24484 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
24487 @cindex Gnus versions
24489 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
24490 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
24491 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
24493 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
24494 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
24496 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
24497 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
24499 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
24500 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
24502 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
24503 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
24506 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun.
24508 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
24509 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
24510 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'' -- don't panic. Don't let it know
24511 that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever you do, don't
24512 run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach. Find a proper
24513 released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
24516 @node Other Gnus Versions
24517 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
24520 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
24521 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
24522 Japan. It's based on a library called @acronym{SEMI}, which provides
24523 @acronym{MIME} capabilities.
24525 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
24526 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
24527 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
24528 @acronym{MIME} and multilingualization things, especially important for
24535 What's the point of Gnus?
24537 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
24538 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
24539 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
24540 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
24541 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
24542 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
24543 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
24544 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
24545 keep track of millions of people who post?
24547 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
24548 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
24549 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
24550 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
24551 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
24552 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
24553 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
24554 every one of you to explore and invent.
24556 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
24557 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
24560 @node Compatibility
24561 @subsection Compatibility
24563 @cindex compatibility
24564 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
24565 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
24566 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
24571 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
24575 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
24578 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
24581 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
24582 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
24583 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
24584 important variables have their values copied into their global
24585 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
24586 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
24588 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
24589 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
24590 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
24591 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
24592 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
24596 @cindex highlighting
24597 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
24598 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
24599 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
24600 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
24601 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
24602 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
24605 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
24606 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
24607 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
24608 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
24610 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
24611 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
24612 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
24613 to stop doing it the old way.
24615 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
24617 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
24619 @cindex reporting bugs
24621 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
24622 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
24623 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
24625 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
24626 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
24627 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
24628 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
24633 @subsection Conformity
24635 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
24636 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
24644 There are no known breaches of this standard.
24648 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
24650 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
24651 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
24652 We do have some breaches to this one.
24658 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
24659 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
24660 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
24661 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
24662 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
24667 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
24668 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
24669 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
24670 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
24672 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
24673 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
24674 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
24676 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
24677 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
24679 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
24682 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
24683 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
24684 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
24685 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
24686 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
24689 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
24690 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
24691 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RF 1991/2440 format.
24692 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
24694 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
24695 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
24697 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
24698 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
24699 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
24700 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
24701 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
24702 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
24703 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
24704 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
24708 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
24709 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
24714 @subsection Emacsen
24720 Gnus should work on:
24728 XEmacs 21.1 and up.
24732 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
24733 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
24736 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
24737 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
24738 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
24742 @node Gnus Development
24743 @subsection Gnus Development
24745 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
24746 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
24747 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
24748 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
24749 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
24750 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
24751 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
24752 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
24754 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
24755 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
24756 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
24757 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
24758 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
24761 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
24762 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
24763 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
24764 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
24765 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
24767 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
24768 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
24769 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
24770 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
24771 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
24772 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
24773 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
24774 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
24775 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
24776 can't be assumed to do so.
24781 @subsection Contributors
24782 @cindex contributors
24784 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
24785 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
24786 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
24787 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
24788 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
24789 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
24790 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
24791 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
24792 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
24793 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
24795 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
24801 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
24804 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
24805 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
24806 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
24807 functionality and stuff.
24810 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
24811 well as numerous other things).
24814 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
24817 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
24820 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
24823 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
24826 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
24827 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
24830 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
24833 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
24834 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
24837 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
24840 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
24843 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
24846 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
24849 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
24850 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
24853 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
24856 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
24859 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
24862 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
24866 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
24869 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
24872 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
24875 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
24876 well as autoconf support.
24880 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
24881 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
24883 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
24898 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
24900 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
24904 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
24914 Alexei V. Barantsev,
24929 Massimo Campostrini,
24934 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
24935 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
24939 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
24942 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
24948 Michael Welsh Duggan,
24953 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
24957 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
24965 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
24967 Michelangelo Grigni,
24971 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
24973 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
24975 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
24982 François Felix Ingrand,
24983 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
24984 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
24986 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
24996 Peter Skov Knudsen,
24997 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
24999 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
25000 Thor Kristoffersen,
25003 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
25021 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
25022 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
25029 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
25034 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
25038 John McClary Prevost,
25044 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
25049 Christian von Roques,
25052 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
25059 Philippe Schnoebelen,
25061 Randal L. Schwartz,
25075 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
25080 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
25100 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
25101 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
25102 (550kB and counting).
25104 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
25107 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
25108 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
25112 @subsection New Features
25113 @cindex new features
25116 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
25117 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
25118 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
25119 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
25120 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
25121 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
25124 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
25125 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
25126 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
25129 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
25131 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
25136 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
25137 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
25140 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
25141 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
25144 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
25147 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
25148 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
25149 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
25152 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
25153 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
25154 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
25155 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25158 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
25159 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25162 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
25163 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
25164 (@pxref{The Active File}).
25167 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
25168 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
25171 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
25172 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
25173 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25176 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
25177 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
25178 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
25181 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
25182 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
25185 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
25186 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
25189 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
25190 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
25193 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
25194 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25197 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
25198 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
25201 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
25202 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25205 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
25208 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
25209 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
25212 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
25213 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
25216 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
25217 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25220 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
25223 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
25224 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25227 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
25231 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
25235 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
25236 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
25239 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
25245 @node September Gnus
25246 @subsubsection September Gnus
25250 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
25254 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
25259 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
25260 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
25264 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
25265 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
25269 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
25273 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
25274 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
25277 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
25281 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25284 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
25287 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
25290 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
25294 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
25295 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
25298 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
25302 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
25306 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
25310 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
25314 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
25317 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
25318 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
25321 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
25325 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
25326 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
25329 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
25332 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
25333 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
25334 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25337 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
25341 The Gnus cache is much faster.
25344 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
25348 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
25349 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
25352 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
25353 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
25356 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
25357 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
25360 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
25361 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
25362 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
25365 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
25366 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
25369 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
25372 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25375 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
25378 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
25381 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
25382 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
25385 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
25389 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
25392 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
25397 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
25400 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
25404 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25407 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
25411 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
25414 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
25417 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
25418 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25421 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
25422 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
25426 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
25427 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
25430 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
25434 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
25435 buffer to allow easier treatment.
25438 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
25441 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
25445 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
25449 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
25450 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
25453 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
25457 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
25458 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25461 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
25462 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25465 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
25469 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25472 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
25475 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
25481 @subsubsection Red Gnus
25483 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
25487 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
25494 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
25497 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
25498 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25501 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
25502 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
25506 Article washing status can be displayed in the
25507 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
25510 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
25513 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
25514 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
25517 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
25521 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
25522 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
25526 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
25527 Server Internals}).
25530 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
25534 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
25537 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
25538 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
25541 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
25542 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
25543 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
25546 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
25547 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25550 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
25551 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
25554 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
25558 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
25559 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25562 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
25563 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25566 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
25570 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
25573 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
25577 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
25578 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25581 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
25582 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25585 A new command for reading collections of documents
25586 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
25587 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
25590 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
25594 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
25595 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
25598 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
25599 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
25600 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
25603 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
25604 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
25608 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
25612 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
25616 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
25621 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
25625 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
25629 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
25630 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
25633 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
25639 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
25641 New features in Gnus 5.6:
25646 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
25647 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
25648 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
25651 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
25652 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
25653 group, which is created automatically.
25656 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
25660 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
25663 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
25664 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
25667 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
25671 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
25674 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
25675 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
25678 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
25681 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
25685 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
25686 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
25689 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
25690 control over simplification.
25693 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
25696 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
25700 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
25703 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
25706 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
25707 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
25708 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
25711 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
25712 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
25715 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
25719 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
25720 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
25723 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
25724 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
25727 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
25731 A history of where mails have been split is available.
25734 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
25737 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
25738 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
25741 A new function for citing in Message has been
25742 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
25745 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
25748 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
25752 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
25753 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
25756 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
25757 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
25760 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
25763 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
25767 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
25768 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
25770 New features in Gnus 5.8:
25775 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
25776 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
25778 If you used procmail like in
25781 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
25782 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
25783 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
25784 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
25787 this now has changed to
25791 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
25795 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
25798 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
25799 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
25802 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
25803 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
25806 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
25807 called to position point.
25810 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
25811 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
25814 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
25815 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
25818 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
25819 subtly different manner.
25822 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
25823 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
25824 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
25827 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
25832 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
25835 New features in Gnus 5.10:
25840 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
25841 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
25842 region if the region is active.
25845 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
25849 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
25850 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
25853 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
25854 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
25857 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
25859 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
25860 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
25861 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
25862 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
25863 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
25864 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
25865 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
25866 isn't save in general.
25871 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
25872 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
25873 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
25874 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
25879 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
25880 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
25881 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
25885 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
25888 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
25893 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
25894 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
25896 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
25897 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
25901 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
25902 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
25905 Retrieval of charters and control messages
25907 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
25908 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
25913 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
25914 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
25915 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
25918 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
25919 decompressed when activated.
25922 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
25923 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
25926 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
25929 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
25930 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
25933 Warn about email replies to news
25935 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
25936 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
25940 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
25941 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
25945 The new @code{recent} mark @samp{.} indicates newly arrived messages (as
25946 opposed to old but unread messages).
25949 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
25950 Gcc articles as read.
25953 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
25956 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
25957 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
25960 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
25961 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
25964 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
25965 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
25968 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
25969 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
25972 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
25974 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
25975 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GNUTLS. The old
25976 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} support via (external third party)
25977 @file{ssl.el} and OpenSSL still works.
25980 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
25982 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
25983 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
25984 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, iff you want
25985 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
25986 the second parameter.
25988 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
25989 automatic recognition of XEmacs and GNU Emacs, generates
25990 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
25991 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
25992 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
25993 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
25994 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
25995 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
25996 cycle used under Unix systems.
25998 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} superfluous, so it has
26002 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
26004 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
26005 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
26006 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
26007 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
26008 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
26012 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
26014 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
26015 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
26016 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
26017 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
26021 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
26023 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
26024 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
26025 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
26026 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
26028 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
26029 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
26030 message cited below.
26033 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
26036 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
26038 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
26039 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
26040 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
26041 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
26042 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
26045 (setq gnus-parameters
26047 (gnus-show-threads nil)
26048 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
26049 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
26050 (to-group . "\\1"))))
26054 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now iconized for Emacs too.
26056 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
26060 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
26062 Earlier it was generated iff the user configurable email address was
26063 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
26064 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
26065 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
26066 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
26067 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
26068 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
26069 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
26070 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
26073 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
26075 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
26076 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
26077 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
26078 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
26079 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
26080 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
26083 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
26084 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
26088 Improved anti-spam features.
26090 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
26091 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
26092 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
26093 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
26094 are also new. @xref{Thwarting Email Spam}.
26097 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers.
26100 Face headers handling.
26103 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
26104 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
26107 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
26110 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
26112 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
26113 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
26114 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
26115 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
26116 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
26117 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
26118 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
26119 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
26120 when getting new mail, remove the function.
26123 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
26125 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
26126 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
26127 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
26128 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
26129 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
26130 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
26131 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
26132 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
26133 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
26134 was inserted directly.
26137 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
26139 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
26140 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
26146 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
26147 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
26148 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
26149 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
26150 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
26151 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
26152 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
26153 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
26154 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
26155 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
26156 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
26157 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
26158 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
26159 is not needed any more.
26162 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
26164 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
26165 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
26166 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
26167 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
26168 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
26172 @file{deuglify.el} (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article})
26174 A new file from Raymond Scholz @email{rscholz@@zonix.de} for deuglifying
26175 broken Outlook (Express) articles.
26178 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
26180 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
26181 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
26182 lisp directory into load-path.
26184 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
26185 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
26188 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
26190 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
26193 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
26195 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
26196 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
26197 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
26198 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
26201 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
26203 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
26205 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
26206 'bbdb-complete-name)
26210 Externalizing and deleting of attachments.
26212 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
26213 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
26214 local files as external parts.
26216 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
26217 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
26218 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
26219 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
26220 that support editing.
26223 @code{gnus-default-charset}
26225 The default value is determined from the
26226 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
26227 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
26228 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
26231 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
26233 Add a new format of match like
26235 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
26236 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26238 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
26240 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
26241 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26245 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
26247 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
26248 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
26249 need add those two headers too.
26252 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
26254 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
26255 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
26256 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
26259 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
26260 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
26261 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
26265 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
26267 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
26270 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
26272 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
26275 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
26277 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
26278 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
26279 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
26282 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
26284 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
26288 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
26290 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
26291 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
26292 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
26293 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
26294 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
26295 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
26296 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
26297 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
26300 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
26302 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
26303 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
26304 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
26305 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
26306 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
26309 Extended format specs.
26311 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
26312 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
26313 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
26314 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
26315 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
26316 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
26319 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
26321 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
26322 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
26323 out other articles.
26326 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
26328 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
26329 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
26330 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
26331 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
26334 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
26336 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
26337 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
26338 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
26341 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
26343 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
26344 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
26345 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
26346 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
26347 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
26348 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
26349 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
26350 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
26351 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
26352 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
26353 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
26356 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
26357 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
26360 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
26361 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
26362 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
26363 message, Message Manual}).
26366 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
26367 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
26369 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
26370 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
26371 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
26373 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
26377 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
26378 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
26380 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
26381 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
26382 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
26383 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
26386 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
26389 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
26392 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
26393 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
26396 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to symbol @code{best}.
26398 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
26399 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
26400 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
26401 invalidate the digital signature.
26408 @section The Manual
26412 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
26413 either @code{texi2dvi}
26415 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
26416 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
26418 to get what you hold in your hands now.
26420 The following conventions have been used:
26425 This is a @samp{string}
26428 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
26431 This is a @file{file}
26434 This is a @code{symbol}
26438 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
26442 (setq flargnoze "yes")
26445 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
26448 (setq flumphel 'yes)
26451 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
26452 ever get them confused.
26456 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
26457 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
26458 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
26459 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
26460 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
26461 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
26462 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
26468 @node On Writing Manuals
26469 @section On Writing Manuals
26471 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
26472 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
26473 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
26474 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
26475 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
26476 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code goes
26479 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
26480 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
26481 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
26484 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
26485 reference manual as source material. It would look quite differently.
26490 @section Terminology
26492 @cindex terminology
26497 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
26498 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
26499 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
26500 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
26501 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
26505 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
26506 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
26507 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
26508 not posting, and replying is not following up.
26512 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
26516 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
26521 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
26522 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
26523 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
26524 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
26525 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
26526 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
26527 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
26528 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
26529 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
26532 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
26533 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
26534 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
26535 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
26536 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
26537 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
26539 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
26540 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
26541 access the articles.
26543 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
26544 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
26545 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
26550 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
26551 default, way of getting news.
26555 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
26556 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
26561 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
26562 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
26566 A message that has been posted as news.
26569 @cindex mail message
26570 A message that has been mailed.
26574 A mail message or news article
26578 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
26583 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
26588 A line from the head of an article.
26592 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
26593 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
26595 @item @acronym{NOV}
26596 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
26597 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
26598 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
26599 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
26600 normal @sc{head} format.
26604 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
26605 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
26606 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
26607 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
26608 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
26609 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
26611 @item killed groups
26612 @cindex killed groups
26613 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
26614 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
26616 @item zombie groups
26617 @cindex zombie groups
26618 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
26621 @cindex active file
26622 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
26623 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
26624 is rather large, as you might surmise.
26627 @cindex bogus groups
26628 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
26629 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
26630 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
26633 @cindex activating groups
26634 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
26635 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
26636 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
26640 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
26641 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
26642 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
26646 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
26648 @item select method
26649 @cindex select method
26650 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
26653 @item virtual server
26654 @cindex virtual server
26655 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
26656 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
26657 whole is a virtual server.
26661 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
26662 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
26665 @item ephemeral groups
26666 @cindex ephemeral groups
26667 @cindex temporary groups
26668 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
26669 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
26670 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
26673 @cindex solid groups
26674 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
26675 group buffer are solid groups.
26677 @item sparse articles
26678 @cindex sparse articles
26679 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
26680 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
26684 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
26685 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
26689 @cindex thread root
26690 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
26691 articles in the thread.
26695 An article that has responses.
26699 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
26703 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
26704 specified by RFC 1153.
26707 @cindex splitting, terminolgy
26708 @cindex mail sorting
26709 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
26710 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
26711 incorrectly called mail filtering.
26717 @node Customization
26718 @section Customization
26719 @cindex general customization
26721 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
26722 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
26723 for some quite common situations.
26726 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
26727 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
26728 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
26729 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
26733 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
26734 @subsection Slow/Expensive NNTP Connection
26736 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
26737 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
26738 Gnus has to get from the @acronym{NNTP} server.
26742 @item gnus-read-active-file
26743 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
26744 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
26745 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
26746 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
26747 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
26749 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
26750 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
26751 the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast. Not all @acronym{NNTP} servers
26752 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
26756 @node Slow Terminal Connection
26757 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
26759 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
26760 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
26761 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
26765 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
26766 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
26767 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
26768 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
26769 horizontal and vertical recentering.
26771 @item gnus-visible-headers
26772 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
26773 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
26774 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
26775 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
26777 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
26779 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
26780 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
26781 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
26784 @item gnus-use-full-window
26785 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
26786 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
26787 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
26788 want to read them anyway.
26790 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
26791 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
26795 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
26796 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
26797 lines, which might save some time.
26801 @node Little Disk Space
26802 @subsection Little Disk Space
26805 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
26806 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
26810 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
26811 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
26812 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
26813 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
26816 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
26817 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
26818 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
26819 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
26822 @item gnus-save-killed-list
26823 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
26824 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
26825 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
26826 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
26832 @subsection Slow Machine
26833 @cindex slow machine
26835 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
26836 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
26838 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
26839 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
26841 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
26842 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
26843 summary buffer faster.
26847 @node Troubleshooting
26848 @section Troubleshooting
26849 @cindex troubleshooting
26851 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
26859 Make sure your computer is switched on.
26862 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
26863 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
26867 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
26868 like @samp{Gnus v5.10.6} you have the right files loaded. Otherwise
26869 you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
26872 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
26873 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
26876 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
26877 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
26878 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
26879 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
26880 something like that.
26883 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
26886 @cindex reporting bugs
26888 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26890 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
26891 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
26892 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
26893 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
26895 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
26896 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
26897 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
26898 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
26901 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
26902 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
26903 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
26904 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
26905 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
26906 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
26908 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
26909 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
26910 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
26914 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
26915 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
26918 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
26919 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
26920 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
26921 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
26922 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
26923 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
26924 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
26925 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
26926 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
26927 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
26928 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
26929 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
26930 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
26931 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
26936 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
26937 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
26938 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
26939 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
26940 helps isolating the real problem areas).
26942 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
26943 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
26944 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
26945 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
26946 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
26947 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
26948 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
26949 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
26950 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
26951 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
26952 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
26953 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
26954 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
26957 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
26958 @cindex ding mailing list
26959 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
26960 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
26961 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
26962 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
26966 @node Gnus Reference Guide
26967 @section Gnus Reference Guide
26969 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
26970 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
26971 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
26972 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
26975 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
26976 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
26977 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
26978 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
26979 and general methods of operation.
26982 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
26983 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
26984 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
26985 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
26986 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
26987 * Group Info:: The group info format.
26988 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
26989 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
26990 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
26994 @node Gnus Utility Functions
26995 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
26996 @cindex Gnus utility functions
26997 @cindex utility functions
26999 @cindex internal variables
27001 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
27002 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
27003 Below is a list of the most common ones.
27007 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
27008 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
27009 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
27011 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
27012 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
27013 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
27015 @item gnus-group-real-name
27016 @findex gnus-group-real-name
27017 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
27020 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
27021 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
27022 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
27023 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
27025 @item gnus-get-info
27026 @findex gnus-get-info
27027 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
27029 @item gnus-group-unread
27030 @findex gnus-group-unread
27031 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
27035 @findex gnus-active
27036 The active entry for @var{group}.
27038 @item gnus-set-active
27039 @findex gnus-set-active
27040 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
27042 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27043 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27044 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
27047 @item gnus-continuum-version
27048 @findex gnus-continuum-version
27049 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
27050 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
27053 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
27054 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
27055 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
27057 @item gnus-news-group-p
27058 @findex gnus-news-group-p
27059 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
27061 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27062 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27063 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
27065 @item gnus-server-to-method
27066 @findex gnus-server-to-method
27067 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
27069 @item gnus-server-equal
27070 @findex gnus-server-equal
27071 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
27073 @item gnus-group-native-p
27074 @findex gnus-group-native-p
27075 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
27077 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
27078 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
27079 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
27081 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
27082 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
27083 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
27085 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
27086 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
27087 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
27088 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
27090 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
27091 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
27092 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
27094 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
27095 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
27096 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
27098 @item gnus-check-backend-function
27099 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
27100 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
27101 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
27104 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
27108 @item gnus-read-method
27109 @findex gnus-read-method
27110 Prompts the user for a select method.
27115 @node Back End Interface
27116 @subsection Back End Interface
27118 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
27119 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
27120 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
27121 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
27122 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
27123 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
27125 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
27126 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
27127 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
27128 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
27129 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
27130 been opened, the function should fail.
27132 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
27133 name. Take this example:
27137 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
27138 (nntp-port-number 4324))
27141 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
27142 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
27144 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
27145 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
27146 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
27148 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
27149 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
27150 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
27152 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
27153 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
27154 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
27155 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
27156 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
27157 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
27160 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
27161 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
27162 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
27163 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
27166 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
27167 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
27168 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
27169 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
27170 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
27171 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
27172 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
27173 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
27174 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
27175 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
27177 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
27178 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
27179 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
27180 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
27181 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
27182 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
27183 of numbers as long as possible.
27185 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
27186 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
27187 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
27189 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
27192 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
27195 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
27196 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
27197 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
27198 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
27199 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
27200 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
27204 @node Required Back End Functions
27205 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
27209 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
27211 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
27212 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
27213 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
27214 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
27216 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
27217 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
27218 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
27219 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
27221 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
27222 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
27223 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
27224 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
27225 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
27226 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
27227 number, do maximum fetches.
27229 Here's an example HEAD:
27232 221 1056 Article retrieved.
27233 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
27234 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
27235 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
27236 Subject: Re: Something very droll
27237 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
27238 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
27240 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
27241 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
27242 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
27246 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
27247 these in the data buffer.
27249 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
27253 head = error / valid-head
27254 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
27255 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
27256 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
27257 header = <text> eol
27261 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
27263 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
27264 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
27268 nov-buffer = *nov-line
27269 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
27270 field = <text except TAB>
27273 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
27277 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
27279 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
27280 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
27282 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
27283 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
27284 server. In fact, it should do so.
27286 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
27287 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
27290 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
27292 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
27293 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
27296 There should be no data returned.
27299 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
27301 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
27302 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
27303 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
27304 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
27306 There should be no data returned.
27309 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
27311 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
27312 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
27313 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
27314 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
27316 There should be no data returned.
27319 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
27321 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
27323 There should be no data returned.
27326 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
27328 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
27329 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
27330 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
27331 it would be nice if that were possible.
27333 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
27334 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
27335 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
27336 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
27337 into its article buffer.
27339 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
27340 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
27341 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
27342 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
27343 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
27344 on successful article retrieval.
27347 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
27349 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
27350 making @var{group} the current group.
27352 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
27355 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
27358 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
27361 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
27362 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
27363 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
27364 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
27365 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
27366 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
27367 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
27368 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
27369 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
27373 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
27374 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
27375 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
27379 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27381 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
27382 a no-op on most back ends.
27384 There should be no data returned.
27387 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
27389 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
27392 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
27395 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
27396 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
27399 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
27400 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
27401 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
27402 and the highest as 0.
27405 active-file = *active-line
27406 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
27408 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
27411 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
27412 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
27413 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
27416 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
27418 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
27419 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
27420 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
27421 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
27422 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
27423 clear if the posting could not be completed.
27425 There should be no result data from this function.
27430 @node Optional Back End Functions
27431 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
27435 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
27437 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
27438 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
27439 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
27441 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
27442 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
27443 former is in the same format as the data from
27444 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
27445 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
27448 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
27452 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
27454 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
27455 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
27456 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
27457 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
27458 should return a non-@code{nil} value.
27460 There should be no result data from this function.
27463 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
27465 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
27466 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
27467 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
27468 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
27469 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
27470 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
27471 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
27472 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
27474 There should be no result data from this function.
27477 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
27479 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
27480 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
27481 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
27482 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
27483 propagate the mark information to the server.
27485 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
27488 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
27491 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
27492 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
27493 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
27494 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
27495 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
27496 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend},
27497 @code{forward} and @code{recent}, but your back end should, if
27498 possible, not limit itself to these.
27500 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
27501 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
27502 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
27503 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
27505 An example action list:
27508 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
27509 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
27510 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
27513 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
27514 mark on (currently not used for anything).
27516 There should be no result data from this function.
27518 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
27520 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
27521 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
27522 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
27523 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
27524 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
27526 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
27527 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
27528 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
27531 There should be no result data from this function.
27534 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
27536 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
27537 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
27538 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
27539 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
27540 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
27541 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
27542 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
27543 local if that's practical.
27545 There should be no result data from this function.
27548 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
27550 The result data from this function should be a description of
27554 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
27556 description = <text>
27559 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
27561 The result data from this function should be the description of all
27562 groups available on the server.
27565 description-buffer = *description-line
27569 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
27571 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
27572 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
27573 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
27574 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
27575 in the active buffer format.
27577 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
27578 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
27579 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
27580 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
27581 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
27582 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
27583 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
27586 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27588 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
27590 There should be no return data.
27593 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
27595 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
27596 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
27597 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
27598 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
27599 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
27602 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
27605 There should be no result data returned.
27608 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
27610 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
27611 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
27613 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
27614 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
27615 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
27616 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
27617 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
27618 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
27620 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
27621 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
27624 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27625 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27627 There should be no data returned.
27630 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
27632 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
27633 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
27634 this function in short order.
27636 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27637 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27639 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
27640 article for that group.
27642 There should be no data returned.
27645 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
27647 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
27648 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
27650 There should be no data returned.
27653 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
27655 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
27656 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
27657 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
27659 There should be no data returned.
27662 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
27664 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
27665 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
27667 There should be no data returned.
27672 @node Error Messaging
27673 @subsubsection Error Messaging
27675 @findex nnheader-report
27676 @findex nnheader-get-report
27677 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
27678 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
27679 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
27680 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
27681 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
27682 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
27685 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
27687 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
27690 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
27691 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
27692 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
27693 takes one argument---the server symbol.
27695 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
27696 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
27697 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
27700 @node Writing New Back Ends
27701 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
27703 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
27704 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
27705 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
27706 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
27707 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
27710 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
27711 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
27712 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
27714 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
27715 package called @code{nnoo}.
27717 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
27718 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
27724 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
27725 parameters. For instance:
27728 (nnoo-declare nndir
27732 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
27733 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
27736 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
27737 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
27738 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
27740 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
27741 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
27742 a function in those back ends.
27745 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
27746 "Where nndir will look for groups."
27747 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
27750 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
27751 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
27752 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
27754 @item nnoo-define-basics
27755 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
27759 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
27763 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
27764 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
27765 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
27767 @item nnoo-map-functions
27768 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
27769 functions from the parent back ends.
27772 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
27773 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27774 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
27777 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
27778 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
27779 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
27780 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
27783 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
27784 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
27785 haven't already been defined.
27791 nnmh-request-newgroups)
27795 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
27796 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
27797 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
27802 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
27805 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
27806 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
27810 (require 'nnheader)
27814 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
27816 (nnoo-declare nndir
27819 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
27820 "Where nndir will look for groups."
27821 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
27823 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
27824 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
27827 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
27829 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
27830 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
27831 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
27833 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
27834 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
27836 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
27838 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
27840 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
27841 (setq nndir-directory
27842 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
27844 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
27845 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
27846 (push `(nndir-current-group
27847 ,(file-name-nondirectory
27848 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
27850 (push `(nndir-top-directory
27851 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
27853 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
27855 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
27856 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27857 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27858 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
27859 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
27863 nnmh-status-message
27865 nnmh-request-newgroups))
27871 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
27872 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
27874 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
27875 @findex gnus-declare-backend
27876 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
27877 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
27878 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
27880 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
27881 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
27886 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
27889 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
27891 The abilities can be:
27895 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
27897 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
27899 This back end supports both mail and news.
27901 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
27904 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
27905 articles and groups.
27907 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
27908 true for almost all back ends.
27909 @item prompt-address
27910 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
27911 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
27912 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
27916 @node Mail-like Back Ends
27917 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
27919 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
27920 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
27921 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
27922 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
27925 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
27926 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
27927 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
27930 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
27931 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
27934 This function takes four parameters.
27938 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
27941 @item exit-function
27942 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
27944 @item temp-directory
27945 Where the temporary files should be stored.
27948 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
27949 performed for one group only.
27952 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
27953 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
27954 find the article number assigned to this article.
27956 The function also uses the following variables:
27957 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
27958 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
27959 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
27960 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
27964 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
27965 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
27969 @node Score File Syntax
27970 @subsection Score File Syntax
27972 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
27973 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
27974 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
27976 Here's a typical score file:
27980 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
27987 BNF definition of a score file:
27990 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
27991 element = rule / atom
27992 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
27993 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
27994 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
27995 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
27997 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
27998 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
27999 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
28000 date-header = "date"
28001 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28002 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28003 score = "nil" / <integer>
28004 date = "nil" / <natural number>
28005 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
28006 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
28007 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
28008 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
28009 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28010 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28011 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
28012 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28013 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
28014 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
28015 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
28016 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
28017 exclude-files / read-only / touched
28018 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
28019 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
28020 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
28021 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
28022 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
28023 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
28024 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
28025 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
28026 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
28027 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
28028 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
28029 eval = "eval" space <form>
28030 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
28033 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
28036 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
28037 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
28038 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
28039 one looong line, then that's ok.
28041 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
28042 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
28046 @subsection Headers
28048 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
28049 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
28050 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
28051 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
28053 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
28054 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
28055 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
28056 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
28057 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
28058 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
28059 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
28061 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
28062 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
28063 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
28064 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
28065 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
28067 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
28068 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
28074 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
28075 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
28077 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
28078 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
28079 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
28080 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
28082 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
28086 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
28089 is transformed into
28092 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
28095 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
28096 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
28099 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
28102 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
28103 is slightly tricky:
28106 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
28112 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
28115 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
28121 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
28128 and is equal to the previous range.
28130 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
28131 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
28132 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
28136 range = simple-range / normal-range
28137 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
28138 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
28139 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
28140 number *[ " " contents ]
28143 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
28144 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
28145 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
28146 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
28147 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
28152 @subsection Group Info
28154 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
28155 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
28156 describes the group.
28158 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
28159 second is a more complex one:
28162 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
28164 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
28165 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
28167 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
28170 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
28171 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
28172 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
28173 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
28174 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
28175 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
28176 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
28177 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
28178 this section is about.
28180 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
28181 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
28182 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
28184 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
28187 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
28188 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
28189 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28190 group = quote <string> quote
28191 ralevel = rank / level
28192 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28193 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
28194 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28196 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
28197 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
28198 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
28199 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
28202 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
28203 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
28206 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
28207 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
28210 @item gnus-info-group
28211 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
28212 @findex gnus-info-group
28213 @findex gnus-info-set-group
28214 Get/set the group name.
28216 @item gnus-info-rank
28217 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
28218 @findex gnus-info-rank
28219 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
28220 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
28222 @item gnus-info-level
28223 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
28224 @findex gnus-info-level
28225 @findex gnus-info-set-level
28226 Get/set the group level.
28228 @item gnus-info-score
28229 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
28230 @findex gnus-info-score
28231 @findex gnus-info-set-score
28232 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
28234 @item gnus-info-read
28235 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
28236 @findex gnus-info-read
28237 @findex gnus-info-set-read
28238 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
28240 @item gnus-info-marks
28241 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
28242 @findex gnus-info-marks
28243 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
28244 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
28246 @item gnus-info-method
28247 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
28248 @findex gnus-info-method
28249 @findex gnus-info-set-method
28250 Get/set the group select method.
28252 @item gnus-info-params
28253 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
28254 @findex gnus-info-params
28255 @findex gnus-info-set-params
28256 Get/set the group parameters.
28259 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
28260 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
28262 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
28263 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
28264 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
28265 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
28268 @node Extended Interactive
28269 @subsection Extended Interactive
28270 @cindex interactive
28271 @findex gnus-interactive
28273 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
28274 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
28275 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
28278 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
28279 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
28284 The best thing to do would have been to implement
28285 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
28286 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
28287 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
28288 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
28289 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
28290 @code{interactive}.
28292 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
28297 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
28298 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
28302 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
28303 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
28304 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
28307 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
28311 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
28315 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
28321 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
28322 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
28326 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
28327 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
28328 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
28330 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
28331 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
28332 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
28333 Gnus, that's very useful.
28335 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
28336 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
28337 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
28338 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
28339 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
28340 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
28341 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
28342 following function:
28345 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
28349 (,function ,@@args))
28353 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
28354 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
28355 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
28358 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
28359 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
28360 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
28362 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
28363 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
28364 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
28367 @node Various File Formats
28368 @subsection Various File Formats
28371 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
28372 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
28376 @node Active File Format
28377 @subsubsection Active File Format
28379 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
28380 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
28383 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
28386 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
28387 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
28388 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
28389 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
28390 no.general 1000 900 y
28393 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
28396 active = *group-line
28397 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
28398 group = <non-white-space string>
28400 high-number = <non-negative integer>
28401 low-number = <positive integer>
28402 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
28405 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
28406 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
28409 @node Newsgroups File Format
28410 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
28412 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
28413 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
28414 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
28417 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
28418 Here's the definition:
28422 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
28423 group = <non-white-space string>
28425 description = <string>
28430 @node Emacs for Heathens
28431 @section Emacs for Heathens
28433 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
28434 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
28435 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
28436 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
28437 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
28438 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
28439 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
28443 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
28444 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
28449 @subsection Keystrokes
28453 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
28456 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
28459 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
28460 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
28461 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
28462 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
28463 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
28464 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
28466 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
28467 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
28468 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
28469 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
28470 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
28471 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
28472 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
28474 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
28475 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
28476 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
28477 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
28478 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
28479 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
28480 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
28482 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
28483 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
28484 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
28485 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
28486 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
28492 @subsection Emacs Lisp
28494 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
28495 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
28496 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
28497 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
28499 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
28500 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
28501 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
28502 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
28503 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
28504 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
28505 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
28506 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
28507 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
28508 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
28510 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
28511 write the following:
28514 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
28517 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
28518 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
28519 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
28520 change how Gnus works.
28522 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
28523 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
28524 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
28525 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
28526 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
28528 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
28529 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
28530 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
28534 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
28538 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
28541 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
28542 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
28545 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
28548 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
28549 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
28552 @include gnus-faq.texi
28572 @c Local Variables:
28574 @c coding: iso-8859-1
28578 arch-tag: c9fa47e7-78ca-4681-bda9-9fef45d1c819